1 /* vi:set ts=8 sts=4 sw=4: 2 * 3 * VIM - Vi IMproved by Bram Moolenaar 4 * 5 * Do ":help uganda" in Vim to read copying and usage conditions. 6 * Do ":help credits" in Vim to see a list of people who contributed. 7 * See README.txt for an overview of the Vim source code. 8 */ 9 10 /* 11 * misc1.c: functions that didn't seem to fit elsewhere 12 */ 13 14 #include "vim.h" 15 #include "version.h" 16 17 static char_u *vim_version_dir __ARGS((char_u *vimdir)); 18 static char_u *remove_tail __ARGS((char_u *p, char_u *pend, char_u *name)); 19 #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) 20 static void init_users __ARGS((void)); 21 #endif 22 static int copy_indent __ARGS((int size, char_u *src)); 23 24 /* All user names (for ~user completion as done by shell). */ 25 #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO) 26 static garray_T ga_users; 27 #endif 28 29 /* 30 * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in the current line. 31 */ 32 int 33 get_indent() 34 { 35 return get_indent_str(ml_get_curline(), (int)curbuf->b_p_ts, FALSE); 36 } 37 38 /* 39 * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "lnum". 40 */ 41 int 42 get_indent_lnum(lnum) 43 linenr_T lnum; 44 { 45 return get_indent_str(ml_get(lnum), (int)curbuf->b_p_ts, FALSE); 46 } 47 48 #if defined(FEAT_FOLDING) || defined(PROTO) 49 /* 50 * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "lnum" of buffer 51 * "buf". 52 */ 53 int 54 get_indent_buf(buf, lnum) 55 buf_T *buf; 56 linenr_T lnum; 57 { 58 return get_indent_str(ml_get_buf(buf, lnum, FALSE), (int)buf->b_p_ts, FALSE); 59 } 60 #endif 61 62 /* 63 * count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "ptr", with 64 * 'tabstop' at "ts" 65 */ 66 int 67 get_indent_str(ptr, ts, list) 68 char_u *ptr; 69 int ts; 70 int list; /* if TRUE, count only screen size for tabs */ 71 { 72 int count = 0; 73 74 for ( ; *ptr; ++ptr) 75 { 76 if (*ptr == TAB) 77 { 78 if (!list || lcs_tab1) /* count a tab for what it is worth */ 79 count += ts - (count % ts); 80 else 81 /* In list mode, when tab is not set, count screen char width 82 * for Tab, displays: ^I */ 83 count += ptr2cells(ptr); 84 } 85 else if (*ptr == ' ') 86 ++count; /* count a space for one */ 87 else 88 break; 89 } 90 return count; 91 } 92 93 /* 94 * Set the indent of the current line. 95 * Leaves the cursor on the first non-blank in the line. 96 * Caller must take care of undo. 97 * "flags": 98 * SIN_CHANGED: call changed_bytes() if the line was changed. 99 * SIN_INSERT: insert the indent in front of the line. 100 * SIN_UNDO: save line for undo before changing it. 101 * Returns TRUE if the line was changed. 102 */ 103 int 104 set_indent(size, flags) 105 int size; /* measured in spaces */ 106 int flags; 107 { 108 char_u *p; 109 char_u *newline; 110 char_u *oldline; 111 char_u *s; 112 int todo; 113 int ind_len; /* measured in characters */ 114 int line_len; 115 int doit = FALSE; 116 int ind_done = 0; /* measured in spaces */ 117 int tab_pad; 118 int retval = FALSE; 119 int orig_char_len = -1; /* number of initial whitespace chars when 120 'et' and 'pi' are both set */ 121 122 /* 123 * First check if there is anything to do and compute the number of 124 * characters needed for the indent. 125 */ 126 todo = size; 127 ind_len = 0; 128 p = oldline = ml_get_curline(); 129 130 /* Calculate the buffer size for the new indent, and check to see if it 131 * isn't already set */ 132 133 /* if 'expandtab' isn't set: use TABs; if both 'expandtab' and 134 * 'preserveindent' are set count the number of characters at the 135 * beginning of the line to be copied */ 136 if (!curbuf->b_p_et || (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi)) 137 { 138 /* If 'preserveindent' is set then reuse as much as possible of 139 * the existing indent structure for the new indent */ 140 if (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi) 141 { 142 ind_done = 0; 143 144 /* count as many characters as we can use */ 145 while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*p)) 146 { 147 if (*p == TAB) 148 { 149 tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts 150 - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); 151 /* stop if this tab will overshoot the target */ 152 if (todo < tab_pad) 153 break; 154 todo -= tab_pad; 155 ++ind_len; 156 ind_done += tab_pad; 157 } 158 else 159 { 160 --todo; 161 ++ind_len; 162 ++ind_done; 163 } 164 ++p; 165 } 166 167 /* Set initial number of whitespace chars to copy if we are 168 * preserving indent but expandtab is set */ 169 if (curbuf->b_p_et) 170 orig_char_len = ind_len; 171 172 /* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */ 173 tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); 174 if (todo >= tab_pad && orig_char_len == -1) 175 { 176 doit = TRUE; 177 todo -= tab_pad; 178 ++ind_len; 179 /* ind_done += tab_pad; */ 180 } 181 } 182 183 /* count tabs required for indent */ 184 while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts) 185 { 186 if (*p != TAB) 187 doit = TRUE; 188 else 189 ++p; 190 todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; 191 ++ind_len; 192 /* ind_done += (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; */ 193 } 194 } 195 /* count spaces required for indent */ 196 while (todo > 0) 197 { 198 if (*p != ' ') 199 doit = TRUE; 200 else 201 ++p; 202 --todo; 203 ++ind_len; 204 /* ++ind_done; */ 205 } 206 207 /* Return if the indent is OK already. */ 208 if (!doit && !vim_iswhite(*p) && !(flags & SIN_INSERT)) 209 return FALSE; 210 211 /* Allocate memory for the new line. */ 212 if (flags & SIN_INSERT) 213 p = oldline; 214 else 215 p = skipwhite(p); 216 line_len = (int)STRLEN(p) + 1; 217 218 /* If 'preserveindent' and 'expandtab' are both set keep the original 219 * characters and allocate accordingly. We will fill the rest with spaces 220 * after the if (!curbuf->b_p_et) below. */ 221 if (orig_char_len != -1) 222 { 223 newline = alloc(orig_char_len + size - ind_done + line_len); 224 if (newline == NULL) 225 return FALSE; 226 todo = size - ind_done; 227 ind_len = orig_char_len + todo; /* Set total length of indent in 228 * characters, which may have been 229 * undercounted until now */ 230 p = oldline; 231 s = newline; 232 while (orig_char_len > 0) 233 { 234 *s++ = *p++; 235 orig_char_len--; 236 } 237 238 /* Skip over any additional white space (useful when newindent is less 239 * than old) */ 240 while (vim_iswhite(*p)) 241 ++p; 242 243 } 244 else 245 { 246 todo = size; 247 newline = alloc(ind_len + line_len); 248 if (newline == NULL) 249 return FALSE; 250 s = newline; 251 } 252 253 /* Put the characters in the new line. */ 254 /* if 'expandtab' isn't set: use TABs */ 255 if (!curbuf->b_p_et) 256 { 257 /* If 'preserveindent' is set then reuse as much as possible of 258 * the existing indent structure for the new indent */ 259 if (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi) 260 { 261 p = oldline; 262 ind_done = 0; 263 264 while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*p)) 265 { 266 if (*p == TAB) 267 { 268 tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts 269 - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); 270 /* stop if this tab will overshoot the target */ 271 if (todo < tab_pad) 272 break; 273 todo -= tab_pad; 274 ind_done += tab_pad; 275 } 276 else 277 { 278 --todo; 279 ++ind_done; 280 } 281 *s++ = *p++; 282 } 283 284 /* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */ 285 tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); 286 if (todo >= tab_pad) 287 { 288 *s++ = TAB; 289 todo -= tab_pad; 290 } 291 292 p = skipwhite(p); 293 } 294 295 while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts) 296 { 297 *s++ = TAB; 298 todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; 299 } 300 } 301 while (todo > 0) 302 { 303 *s++ = ' '; 304 --todo; 305 } 306 mch_memmove(s, p, (size_t)line_len); 307 308 /* Replace the line (unless undo fails). */ 309 if (!(flags & SIN_UNDO) || u_savesub(curwin->w_cursor.lnum) == OK) 310 { 311 ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, newline, FALSE); 312 if (flags & SIN_CHANGED) 313 changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0); 314 /* Correct saved cursor position if it is in this line. */ 315 if (saved_cursor.lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum) 316 { 317 if (saved_cursor.col >= (colnr_T)(p - oldline)) 318 /* cursor was after the indent, adjust for the number of 319 * bytes added/removed */ 320 saved_cursor.col += ind_len - (colnr_T)(p - oldline); 321 else if (saved_cursor.col >= (colnr_T)(s - newline)) 322 /* cursor was in the indent, and is now after it, put it back 323 * at the start of the indent (replacing spaces with TAB) */ 324 saved_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(s - newline); 325 } 326 retval = TRUE; 327 } 328 else 329 vim_free(newline); 330 331 curwin->w_cursor.col = ind_len; 332 return retval; 333 } 334 335 /* 336 * Copy the indent from ptr to the current line (and fill to size) 337 * Leaves the cursor on the first non-blank in the line. 338 * Returns TRUE if the line was changed. 339 */ 340 static int 341 copy_indent(size, src) 342 int size; 343 char_u *src; 344 { 345 char_u *p = NULL; 346 char_u *line = NULL; 347 char_u *s; 348 int todo; 349 int ind_len; 350 int line_len = 0; 351 int tab_pad; 352 int ind_done; 353 int round; 354 355 /* Round 1: compute the number of characters needed for the indent 356 * Round 2: copy the characters. */ 357 for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round) 358 { 359 todo = size; 360 ind_len = 0; 361 ind_done = 0; 362 s = src; 363 364 /* Count/copy the usable portion of the source line */ 365 while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*s)) 366 { 367 if (*s == TAB) 368 { 369 tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts 370 - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); 371 /* Stop if this tab will overshoot the target */ 372 if (todo < tab_pad) 373 break; 374 todo -= tab_pad; 375 ind_done += tab_pad; 376 } 377 else 378 { 379 --todo; 380 ++ind_done; 381 } 382 ++ind_len; 383 if (p != NULL) 384 *p++ = *s; 385 ++s; 386 } 387 388 /* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */ 389 tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); 390 if (todo >= tab_pad && !curbuf->b_p_et) 391 { 392 todo -= tab_pad; 393 ++ind_len; 394 if (p != NULL) 395 *p++ = TAB; 396 } 397 398 /* Add tabs required for indent */ 399 while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts && !curbuf->b_p_et) 400 { 401 todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; 402 ++ind_len; 403 if (p != NULL) 404 *p++ = TAB; 405 } 406 407 /* Count/add spaces required for indent */ 408 while (todo > 0) 409 { 410 --todo; 411 ++ind_len; 412 if (p != NULL) 413 *p++ = ' '; 414 } 415 416 if (p == NULL) 417 { 418 /* Allocate memory for the result: the copied indent, new indent 419 * and the rest of the line. */ 420 line_len = (int)STRLEN(ml_get_curline()) + 1; 421 line = alloc(ind_len + line_len); 422 if (line == NULL) 423 return FALSE; 424 p = line; 425 } 426 } 427 428 /* Append the original line */ 429 mch_memmove(p, ml_get_curline(), (size_t)line_len); 430 431 /* Replace the line */ 432 ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, line, FALSE); 433 434 /* Put the cursor after the indent. */ 435 curwin->w_cursor.col = ind_len; 436 return TRUE; 437 } 438 439 /* 440 * Return the indent of the current line after a number. Return -1 if no 441 * number was found. Used for 'n' in 'formatoptions': numbered list. 442 * Since a pattern is used it can actually handle more than numbers. 443 */ 444 int 445 get_number_indent(lnum) 446 linenr_T lnum; 447 { 448 colnr_T col; 449 pos_T pos; 450 451 regmatch_T regmatch; 452 int lead_len = 0; /* length of comment leader */ 453 454 if (lnum > curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) 455 return -1; 456 pos.lnum = 0; 457 458 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 459 /* In format_lines() (i.e. not insert mode), fo+=q is needed too... */ 460 if ((State & INSERT) || has_format_option(FO_Q_COMS)) 461 lead_len = get_leader_len(ml_get(lnum), NULL, FALSE, TRUE); 462 #endif 463 regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(curbuf->b_p_flp, RE_MAGIC); 464 if (regmatch.regprog != NULL) 465 { 466 regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE; 467 468 /* vim_regexec() expects a pointer to a line. This lets us 469 * start matching for the flp beyond any comment leader... */ 470 if (vim_regexec(®match, ml_get(lnum) + lead_len, (colnr_T)0)) 471 { 472 pos.lnum = lnum; 473 pos.col = (colnr_T)(*regmatch.endp - ml_get(lnum)); 474 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT 475 pos.coladd = 0; 476 #endif 477 } 478 vim_regfree(regmatch.regprog); 479 } 480 481 if (pos.lnum == 0 || *ml_get_pos(&pos) == NUL) 482 return -1; 483 getvcol(curwin, &pos, &col, NULL, NULL); 484 return (int)col; 485 } 486 487 #if defined(FEAT_LINEBREAK) || defined(PROTO) 488 /* 489 * Return appropriate space number for breakindent, taking influencing 490 * parameters into account. Window must be specified, since it is not 491 * necessarily always the current one. 492 */ 493 int 494 get_breakindent_win(wp, line) 495 win_T *wp; 496 char_u *line; /* start of the line */ 497 { 498 static int prev_indent = 0; /* cached indent value */ 499 static long prev_ts = 0L; /* cached tabstop value */ 500 static char_u *prev_line = NULL; /* cached pointer to line */ 501 static int prev_tick = 0; /* changedtick of cached value */ 502 int bri = 0; 503 /* window width minus window margin space, i.e. what rests for text */ 504 const int eff_wwidth = W_WIDTH(wp) 505 - ((wp->w_p_nu || wp->w_p_rnu) 506 && (vim_strchr(p_cpo, CPO_NUMCOL) == NULL) 507 ? number_width(wp) + 1 : 0); 508 509 /* used cached indent, unless pointer or 'tabstop' changed */ 510 if (prev_line != line || prev_ts != wp->w_buffer->b_p_ts 511 || prev_tick != wp->w_buffer->b_changedtick) 512 { 513 prev_line = line; 514 prev_ts = wp->w_buffer->b_p_ts; 515 prev_tick = wp->w_buffer->b_changedtick; 516 prev_indent = get_indent_str(line, 517 (int)wp->w_buffer->b_p_ts, wp->w_p_list); 518 } 519 bri = prev_indent + wp->w_p_brishift; 520 521 /* indent minus the length of the showbreak string */ 522 if (wp->w_p_brisbr) 523 bri -= vim_strsize(p_sbr); 524 525 /* Add offset for number column, if 'n' is in 'cpoptions' */ 526 bri += win_col_off2(wp); 527 528 /* never indent past left window margin */ 529 if (bri < 0) 530 bri = 0; 531 /* always leave at least bri_min characters on the left, 532 * if text width is sufficient */ 533 else if (bri > eff_wwidth - wp->w_p_brimin) 534 bri = (eff_wwidth - wp->w_p_brimin < 0) 535 ? 0 : eff_wwidth - wp->w_p_brimin; 536 537 return bri; 538 } 539 #endif 540 541 542 #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT) 543 544 static int cin_is_cinword __ARGS((char_u *line)); 545 546 /* 547 * Return TRUE if the string "line" starts with a word from 'cinwords'. 548 */ 549 static int 550 cin_is_cinword(line) 551 char_u *line; 552 { 553 char_u *cinw; 554 char_u *cinw_buf; 555 int cinw_len; 556 int retval = FALSE; 557 int len; 558 559 cinw_len = (int)STRLEN(curbuf->b_p_cinw) + 1; 560 cinw_buf = alloc((unsigned)cinw_len); 561 if (cinw_buf != NULL) 562 { 563 line = skipwhite(line); 564 for (cinw = curbuf->b_p_cinw; *cinw; ) 565 { 566 len = copy_option_part(&cinw, cinw_buf, cinw_len, ","); 567 if (STRNCMP(line, cinw_buf, len) == 0 568 && (!vim_iswordc(line[len]) || !vim_iswordc(line[len - 1]))) 569 { 570 retval = TRUE; 571 break; 572 } 573 } 574 vim_free(cinw_buf); 575 } 576 return retval; 577 } 578 #endif 579 580 /* 581 * open_line: Add a new line below or above the current line. 582 * 583 * For VREPLACE mode, we only add a new line when we get to the end of the 584 * file, otherwise we just start replacing the next line. 585 * 586 * Caller must take care of undo. Since VREPLACE may affect any number of 587 * lines however, it may call u_save_cursor() again when starting to change a 588 * new line. 589 * "flags": OPENLINE_DELSPACES delete spaces after cursor 590 * OPENLINE_DO_COM format comments 591 * OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL keep trailing spaces 592 * OPENLINE_MARKFIX adjust mark positions after the line break 593 * OPENLINE_COM_LIST format comments with list or 2nd line indent 594 * 595 * "second_line_indent": indent for after ^^D in Insert mode or if flag 596 * OPENLINE_COM_LIST 597 * 598 * Return TRUE for success, FALSE for failure 599 */ 600 int 601 open_line(dir, flags, second_line_indent) 602 int dir; /* FORWARD or BACKWARD */ 603 int flags; 604 int second_line_indent; 605 { 606 char_u *saved_line; /* copy of the original line */ 607 char_u *next_line = NULL; /* copy of the next line */ 608 char_u *p_extra = NULL; /* what goes to next line */ 609 int less_cols = 0; /* less columns for mark in new line */ 610 int less_cols_off = 0; /* columns to skip for mark adjust */ 611 pos_T old_cursor; /* old cursor position */ 612 int newcol = 0; /* new cursor column */ 613 int newindent = 0; /* auto-indent of the new line */ 614 int n; 615 int trunc_line = FALSE; /* truncate current line afterwards */ 616 int retval = FALSE; /* return value, default is FAIL */ 617 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 618 int extra_len = 0; /* length of p_extra string */ 619 int lead_len; /* length of comment leader */ 620 char_u *lead_flags; /* position in 'comments' for comment leader */ 621 char_u *leader = NULL; /* copy of comment leader */ 622 #endif 623 char_u *allocated = NULL; /* allocated memory */ 624 #if defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT) || defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_LISP) \ 625 || defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) 626 char_u *p; 627 #endif 628 int saved_char = NUL; /* init for GCC */ 629 #if defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT) || defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) 630 pos_T *pos; 631 #endif 632 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 633 int do_si = (!p_paste && curbuf->b_p_si 634 # ifdef FEAT_CINDENT 635 && !curbuf->b_p_cin 636 # endif 637 ); 638 int no_si = FALSE; /* reset did_si afterwards */ 639 int first_char = NUL; /* init for GCC */ 640 #endif 641 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT)) 642 int vreplace_mode; 643 #endif 644 int did_append; /* appended a new line */ 645 int saved_pi = curbuf->b_p_pi; /* copy of preserveindent setting */ 646 647 /* 648 * make a copy of the current line so we can mess with it 649 */ 650 saved_line = vim_strsave(ml_get_curline()); 651 if (saved_line == NULL) /* out of memory! */ 652 return FALSE; 653 654 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE 655 if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG) 656 { 657 /* 658 * With VREPLACE we make a copy of the next line, which we will be 659 * starting to replace. First make the new line empty and let vim play 660 * with the indenting and comment leader to its heart's content. Then 661 * we grab what it ended up putting on the new line, put back the 662 * original line, and call ins_char() to put each new character onto 663 * the line, replacing what was there before and pushing the right 664 * stuff onto the replace stack. -- webb. 665 */ 666 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum < orig_line_count) 667 next_line = vim_strsave(ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1)); 668 else 669 next_line = vim_strsave((char_u *)""); 670 if (next_line == NULL) /* out of memory! */ 671 goto theend; 672 673 /* 674 * In VREPLACE mode, a NL replaces the rest of the line, and starts 675 * replacing the next line, so push all of the characters left on the 676 * line onto the replace stack. We'll push any other characters that 677 * might be replaced at the start of the next line (due to autoindent 678 * etc) a bit later. 679 */ 680 replace_push(NUL); /* Call twice because BS over NL expects it */ 681 replace_push(NUL); 682 p = saved_line + curwin->w_cursor.col; 683 while (*p != NUL) 684 { 685 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 686 if (has_mbyte) 687 p += replace_push_mb(p); 688 else 689 #endif 690 replace_push(*p++); 691 } 692 saved_line[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL; 693 } 694 #endif 695 696 if ((State & INSERT) 697 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE 698 && !(State & VREPLACE_FLAG) 699 #endif 700 ) 701 { 702 p_extra = saved_line + curwin->w_cursor.col; 703 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 704 if (do_si) /* need first char after new line break */ 705 { 706 p = skipwhite(p_extra); 707 first_char = *p; 708 } 709 #endif 710 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 711 extra_len = (int)STRLEN(p_extra); 712 #endif 713 saved_char = *p_extra; 714 *p_extra = NUL; 715 } 716 717 u_clearline(); /* cannot do "U" command when adding lines */ 718 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 719 did_si = FALSE; 720 #endif 721 ai_col = 0; 722 723 /* 724 * If we just did an auto-indent, then we didn't type anything on 725 * the prior line, and it should be truncated. Do this even if 'ai' is not 726 * set because automatically inserting a comment leader also sets did_ai. 727 */ 728 if (dir == FORWARD && did_ai) 729 trunc_line = TRUE; 730 731 /* 732 * If 'autoindent' and/or 'smartindent' is set, try to figure out what 733 * indent to use for the new line. 734 */ 735 if (curbuf->b_p_ai 736 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 737 || do_si 738 #endif 739 ) 740 { 741 /* 742 * count white space on current line 743 */ 744 newindent = get_indent_str(saved_line, (int)curbuf->b_p_ts, FALSE); 745 if (newindent == 0 && !(flags & OPENLINE_COM_LIST)) 746 newindent = second_line_indent; /* for ^^D command in insert mode */ 747 748 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 749 /* 750 * Do smart indenting. 751 * In insert/replace mode (only when dir == FORWARD) 752 * we may move some text to the next line. If it starts with '{' 753 * don't add an indent. Fixes inserting a NL before '{' in line 754 * "if (condition) {" 755 */ 756 if (!trunc_line && do_si && *saved_line != NUL 757 && (p_extra == NULL || first_char != '{')) 758 { 759 char_u *ptr; 760 char_u last_char; 761 762 old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor; 763 ptr = saved_line; 764 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 765 if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM) 766 lead_len = get_leader_len(ptr, NULL, FALSE, TRUE); 767 else 768 lead_len = 0; 769 # endif 770 if (dir == FORWARD) 771 { 772 /* 773 * Skip preprocessor directives, unless they are 774 * recognised as comments. 775 */ 776 if ( 777 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 778 lead_len == 0 && 779 # endif 780 ptr[0] == '#') 781 { 782 while (ptr[0] == '#' && curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) 783 ptr = ml_get(--curwin->w_cursor.lnum); 784 newindent = get_indent(); 785 } 786 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 787 if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM) 788 lead_len = get_leader_len(ptr, NULL, FALSE, TRUE); 789 else 790 lead_len = 0; 791 if (lead_len > 0) 792 { 793 /* 794 * This case gets the following right: 795 * \* 796 * * A comment (read '\' as '/'). 797 * *\ 798 * #define IN_THE_WAY 799 * This should line up here; 800 */ 801 p = skipwhite(ptr); 802 if (p[0] == '/' && p[1] == '*') 803 p++; 804 if (p[0] == '*') 805 { 806 for (p++; *p; p++) 807 { 808 if (p[0] == '/' && p[-1] == '*') 809 { 810 /* 811 * End of C comment, indent should line up 812 * with the line containing the start of 813 * the comment 814 */ 815 curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(p - ptr); 816 if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, NUL)) != NULL) 817 { 818 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; 819 newindent = get_indent(); 820 } 821 } 822 } 823 } 824 } 825 else /* Not a comment line */ 826 # endif 827 { 828 /* Find last non-blank in line */ 829 p = ptr + STRLEN(ptr) - 1; 830 while (p > ptr && vim_iswhite(*p)) 831 --p; 832 last_char = *p; 833 834 /* 835 * find the character just before the '{' or ';' 836 */ 837 if (last_char == '{' || last_char == ';') 838 { 839 if (p > ptr) 840 --p; 841 while (p > ptr && vim_iswhite(*p)) 842 --p; 843 } 844 /* 845 * Try to catch lines that are split over multiple 846 * lines. eg: 847 * if (condition && 848 * condition) { 849 * Should line up here! 850 * } 851 */ 852 if (*p == ')') 853 { 854 curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(p - ptr); 855 if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, '(')) != NULL) 856 { 857 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; 858 newindent = get_indent(); 859 ptr = ml_get_curline(); 860 } 861 } 862 /* 863 * If last character is '{' do indent, without 864 * checking for "if" and the like. 865 */ 866 if (last_char == '{') 867 { 868 did_si = TRUE; /* do indent */ 869 no_si = TRUE; /* don't delete it when '{' typed */ 870 } 871 /* 872 * Look for "if" and the like, use 'cinwords'. 873 * Don't do this if the previous line ended in ';' or 874 * '}'. 875 */ 876 else if (last_char != ';' && last_char != '}' 877 && cin_is_cinword(ptr)) 878 did_si = TRUE; 879 } 880 } 881 else /* dir == BACKWARD */ 882 { 883 /* 884 * Skip preprocessor directives, unless they are 885 * recognised as comments. 886 */ 887 if ( 888 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 889 lead_len == 0 && 890 # endif 891 ptr[0] == '#') 892 { 893 int was_backslashed = FALSE; 894 895 while ((ptr[0] == '#' || was_backslashed) && 896 curwin->w_cursor.lnum < curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) 897 { 898 if (*ptr && ptr[STRLEN(ptr) - 1] == '\\') 899 was_backslashed = TRUE; 900 else 901 was_backslashed = FALSE; 902 ptr = ml_get(++curwin->w_cursor.lnum); 903 } 904 if (was_backslashed) 905 newindent = 0; /* Got to end of file */ 906 else 907 newindent = get_indent(); 908 } 909 p = skipwhite(ptr); 910 if (*p == '}') /* if line starts with '}': do indent */ 911 did_si = TRUE; 912 else /* can delete indent when '{' typed */ 913 can_si_back = TRUE; 914 } 915 curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor; 916 } 917 if (do_si) 918 can_si = TRUE; 919 #endif /* FEAT_SMARTINDENT */ 920 921 did_ai = TRUE; 922 } 923 924 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 925 /* 926 * Find out if the current line starts with a comment leader. 927 * This may then be inserted in front of the new line. 928 */ 929 end_comment_pending = NUL; 930 if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM) 931 lead_len = get_leader_len(saved_line, &lead_flags, dir == BACKWARD, TRUE); 932 else 933 lead_len = 0; 934 if (lead_len > 0) 935 { 936 char_u *lead_repl = NULL; /* replaces comment leader */ 937 int lead_repl_len = 0; /* length of *lead_repl */ 938 char_u lead_middle[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* middle-comment string */ 939 char_u lead_end[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* end-comment string */ 940 char_u *comment_end = NULL; /* where lead_end has been found */ 941 int extra_space = FALSE; /* append extra space */ 942 int current_flag; 943 int require_blank = FALSE; /* requires blank after middle */ 944 char_u *p2; 945 946 /* 947 * If the comment leader has the start, middle or end flag, it may not 948 * be used or may be replaced with the middle leader. 949 */ 950 for (p = lead_flags; *p && *p != ':'; ++p) 951 { 952 if (*p == COM_BLANK) 953 { 954 require_blank = TRUE; 955 continue; 956 } 957 if (*p == COM_START || *p == COM_MIDDLE) 958 { 959 current_flag = *p; 960 if (*p == COM_START) 961 { 962 /* 963 * Doing "O" on a start of comment does not insert leader. 964 */ 965 if (dir == BACKWARD) 966 { 967 lead_len = 0; 968 break; 969 } 970 971 /* find start of middle part */ 972 (void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_middle, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); 973 require_blank = FALSE; 974 } 975 976 /* 977 * Isolate the strings of the middle and end leader. 978 */ 979 while (*p && p[-1] != ':') /* find end of middle flags */ 980 { 981 if (*p == COM_BLANK) 982 require_blank = TRUE; 983 ++p; 984 } 985 (void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_middle, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); 986 987 while (*p && p[-1] != ':') /* find end of end flags */ 988 { 989 /* Check whether we allow automatic ending of comments */ 990 if (*p == COM_AUTO_END) 991 end_comment_pending = -1; /* means we want to set it */ 992 ++p; 993 } 994 n = copy_option_part(&p, lead_end, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); 995 996 if (end_comment_pending == -1) /* we can set it now */ 997 end_comment_pending = lead_end[n - 1]; 998 999 /* 1000 * If the end of the comment is in the same line, don't use 1001 * the comment leader. 1002 */ 1003 if (dir == FORWARD) 1004 { 1005 for (p = saved_line + lead_len; *p; ++p) 1006 if (STRNCMP(p, lead_end, n) == 0) 1007 { 1008 comment_end = p; 1009 lead_len = 0; 1010 break; 1011 } 1012 } 1013 1014 /* 1015 * Doing "o" on a start of comment inserts the middle leader. 1016 */ 1017 if (lead_len > 0) 1018 { 1019 if (current_flag == COM_START) 1020 { 1021 lead_repl = lead_middle; 1022 lead_repl_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_middle); 1023 } 1024 1025 /* 1026 * If we have hit RETURN immediately after the start 1027 * comment leader, then put a space after the middle 1028 * comment leader on the next line. 1029 */ 1030 if (!vim_iswhite(saved_line[lead_len - 1]) 1031 && ((p_extra != NULL 1032 && (int)curwin->w_cursor.col == lead_len) 1033 || (p_extra == NULL 1034 && saved_line[lead_len] == NUL) 1035 || require_blank)) 1036 extra_space = TRUE; 1037 } 1038 break; 1039 } 1040 if (*p == COM_END) 1041 { 1042 /* 1043 * Doing "o" on the end of a comment does not insert leader. 1044 * Remember where the end is, might want to use it to find the 1045 * start (for C-comments). 1046 */ 1047 if (dir == FORWARD) 1048 { 1049 comment_end = skipwhite(saved_line); 1050 lead_len = 0; 1051 break; 1052 } 1053 1054 /* 1055 * Doing "O" on the end of a comment inserts the middle leader. 1056 * Find the string for the middle leader, searching backwards. 1057 */ 1058 while (p > curbuf->b_p_com && *p != ',') 1059 --p; 1060 for (lead_repl = p; lead_repl > curbuf->b_p_com 1061 && lead_repl[-1] != ':'; --lead_repl) 1062 ; 1063 lead_repl_len = (int)(p - lead_repl); 1064 1065 /* We can probably always add an extra space when doing "O" on 1066 * the comment-end */ 1067 extra_space = TRUE; 1068 1069 /* Check whether we allow automatic ending of comments */ 1070 for (p2 = p; *p2 && *p2 != ':'; p2++) 1071 { 1072 if (*p2 == COM_AUTO_END) 1073 end_comment_pending = -1; /* means we want to set it */ 1074 } 1075 if (end_comment_pending == -1) 1076 { 1077 /* Find last character in end-comment string */ 1078 while (*p2 && *p2 != ',') 1079 p2++; 1080 end_comment_pending = p2[-1]; 1081 } 1082 break; 1083 } 1084 if (*p == COM_FIRST) 1085 { 1086 /* 1087 * Comment leader for first line only: Don't repeat leader 1088 * when using "O", blank out leader when using "o". 1089 */ 1090 if (dir == BACKWARD) 1091 lead_len = 0; 1092 else 1093 { 1094 lead_repl = (char_u *)""; 1095 lead_repl_len = 0; 1096 } 1097 break; 1098 } 1099 } 1100 if (lead_len) 1101 { 1102 /* allocate buffer (may concatenate p_extra later) */ 1103 leader = alloc(lead_len + lead_repl_len + extra_space + extra_len 1104 + (second_line_indent > 0 ? second_line_indent : 0) + 1); 1105 allocated = leader; /* remember to free it later */ 1106 1107 if (leader == NULL) 1108 lead_len = 0; 1109 else 1110 { 1111 vim_strncpy(leader, saved_line, lead_len); 1112 1113 /* 1114 * Replace leader with lead_repl, right or left adjusted 1115 */ 1116 if (lead_repl != NULL) 1117 { 1118 int c = 0; 1119 int off = 0; 1120 1121 for (p = lead_flags; *p != NUL && *p != ':'; ) 1122 { 1123 if (*p == COM_RIGHT || *p == COM_LEFT) 1124 c = *p++; 1125 else if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p) || *p == '-') 1126 off = getdigits(&p); 1127 else 1128 ++p; 1129 } 1130 if (c == COM_RIGHT) /* right adjusted leader */ 1131 { 1132 /* find last non-white in the leader to line up with */ 1133 for (p = leader + lead_len - 1; p > leader 1134 && vim_iswhite(*p); --p) 1135 ; 1136 ++p; 1137 1138 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 1139 /* Compute the length of the replaced characters in 1140 * screen characters, not bytes. */ 1141 { 1142 int repl_size = vim_strnsize(lead_repl, 1143 lead_repl_len); 1144 int old_size = 0; 1145 char_u *endp = p; 1146 int l; 1147 1148 while (old_size < repl_size && p > leader) 1149 { 1150 mb_ptr_back(leader, p); 1151 old_size += ptr2cells(p); 1152 } 1153 l = lead_repl_len - (int)(endp - p); 1154 if (l != 0) 1155 mch_memmove(endp + l, endp, 1156 (size_t)((leader + lead_len) - endp)); 1157 lead_len += l; 1158 } 1159 #else 1160 if (p < leader + lead_repl_len) 1161 p = leader; 1162 else 1163 p -= lead_repl_len; 1164 #endif 1165 mch_memmove(p, lead_repl, (size_t)lead_repl_len); 1166 if (p + lead_repl_len > leader + lead_len) 1167 p[lead_repl_len] = NUL; 1168 1169 /* blank-out any other chars from the old leader. */ 1170 while (--p >= leader) 1171 { 1172 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 1173 int l = mb_head_off(leader, p); 1174 1175 if (l > 1) 1176 { 1177 p -= l; 1178 if (ptr2cells(p) > 1) 1179 { 1180 p[1] = ' '; 1181 --l; 1182 } 1183 mch_memmove(p + 1, p + l + 1, 1184 (size_t)((leader + lead_len) - (p + l + 1))); 1185 lead_len -= l; 1186 *p = ' '; 1187 } 1188 else 1189 #endif 1190 if (!vim_iswhite(*p)) 1191 *p = ' '; 1192 } 1193 } 1194 else /* left adjusted leader */ 1195 { 1196 p = skipwhite(leader); 1197 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 1198 /* Compute the length of the replaced characters in 1199 * screen characters, not bytes. Move the part that is 1200 * not to be overwritten. */ 1201 { 1202 int repl_size = vim_strnsize(lead_repl, 1203 lead_repl_len); 1204 int i; 1205 int l; 1206 1207 for (i = 0; p[i] != NUL && i < lead_len; i += l) 1208 { 1209 l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p + i); 1210 if (vim_strnsize(p, i + l) > repl_size) 1211 break; 1212 } 1213 if (i != lead_repl_len) 1214 { 1215 mch_memmove(p + lead_repl_len, p + i, 1216 (size_t)(lead_len - i - (p - leader))); 1217 lead_len += lead_repl_len - i; 1218 } 1219 } 1220 #endif 1221 mch_memmove(p, lead_repl, (size_t)lead_repl_len); 1222 1223 /* Replace any remaining non-white chars in the old 1224 * leader by spaces. Keep Tabs, the indent must 1225 * remain the same. */ 1226 for (p += lead_repl_len; p < leader + lead_len; ++p) 1227 if (!vim_iswhite(*p)) 1228 { 1229 /* Don't put a space before a TAB. */ 1230 if (p + 1 < leader + lead_len && p[1] == TAB) 1231 { 1232 --lead_len; 1233 mch_memmove(p, p + 1, 1234 (leader + lead_len) - p); 1235 } 1236 else 1237 { 1238 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 1239 int l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p); 1240 1241 if (l > 1) 1242 { 1243 if (ptr2cells(p) > 1) 1244 { 1245 /* Replace a double-wide char with 1246 * two spaces */ 1247 --l; 1248 *p++ = ' '; 1249 } 1250 mch_memmove(p + 1, p + l, 1251 (leader + lead_len) - p); 1252 lead_len -= l - 1; 1253 } 1254 #endif 1255 *p = ' '; 1256 } 1257 } 1258 *p = NUL; 1259 } 1260 1261 /* Recompute the indent, it may have changed. */ 1262 if (curbuf->b_p_ai 1263 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 1264 || do_si 1265 #endif 1266 ) 1267 newindent = get_indent_str(leader, (int)curbuf->b_p_ts, FALSE); 1268 1269 /* Add the indent offset */ 1270 if (newindent + off < 0) 1271 { 1272 off = -newindent; 1273 newindent = 0; 1274 } 1275 else 1276 newindent += off; 1277 1278 /* Correct trailing spaces for the shift, so that 1279 * alignment remains equal. */ 1280 while (off > 0 && lead_len > 0 1281 && leader[lead_len - 1] == ' ') 1282 { 1283 /* Don't do it when there is a tab before the space */ 1284 if (vim_strchr(skipwhite(leader), '\t') != NULL) 1285 break; 1286 --lead_len; 1287 --off; 1288 } 1289 1290 /* If the leader ends in white space, don't add an 1291 * extra space */ 1292 if (lead_len > 0 && vim_iswhite(leader[lead_len - 1])) 1293 extra_space = FALSE; 1294 leader[lead_len] = NUL; 1295 } 1296 1297 if (extra_space) 1298 { 1299 leader[lead_len++] = ' '; 1300 leader[lead_len] = NUL; 1301 } 1302 1303 newcol = lead_len; 1304 1305 /* 1306 * if a new indent will be set below, remove the indent that 1307 * is in the comment leader 1308 */ 1309 if (newindent 1310 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 1311 || did_si 1312 #endif 1313 ) 1314 { 1315 while (lead_len && vim_iswhite(*leader)) 1316 { 1317 --lead_len; 1318 --newcol; 1319 ++leader; 1320 } 1321 } 1322 1323 } 1324 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 1325 did_si = can_si = FALSE; 1326 #endif 1327 } 1328 else if (comment_end != NULL) 1329 { 1330 /* 1331 * We have finished a comment, so we don't use the leader. 1332 * If this was a C-comment and 'ai' or 'si' is set do a normal 1333 * indent to align with the line containing the start of the 1334 * comment. 1335 */ 1336 if (comment_end[0] == '*' && comment_end[1] == '/' && 1337 (curbuf->b_p_ai 1338 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 1339 || do_si 1340 #endif 1341 )) 1342 { 1343 old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor; 1344 curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(comment_end - saved_line); 1345 if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, NUL)) != NULL) 1346 { 1347 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; 1348 newindent = get_indent(); 1349 } 1350 curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor; 1351 } 1352 } 1353 } 1354 #endif 1355 1356 /* (State == INSERT || State == REPLACE), only when dir == FORWARD */ 1357 if (p_extra != NULL) 1358 { 1359 *p_extra = saved_char; /* restore char that NUL replaced */ 1360 1361 /* 1362 * When 'ai' set or "flags" has OPENLINE_DELSPACES, skip to the first 1363 * non-blank. 1364 * 1365 * When in REPLACE mode, put the deleted blanks on the replace stack, 1366 * preceded by a NUL, so they can be put back when a BS is entered. 1367 */ 1368 if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State)) 1369 replace_push(NUL); /* end of extra blanks */ 1370 if (curbuf->b_p_ai || (flags & OPENLINE_DELSPACES)) 1371 { 1372 while ((*p_extra == ' ' || *p_extra == '\t') 1373 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 1374 && (!enc_utf8 1375 || !utf_iscomposing(utf_ptr2char(p_extra + 1))) 1376 #endif 1377 ) 1378 { 1379 if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State)) 1380 replace_push(*p_extra); 1381 ++p_extra; 1382 ++less_cols_off; 1383 } 1384 } 1385 if (*p_extra != NUL) 1386 did_ai = FALSE; /* append some text, don't truncate now */ 1387 1388 /* columns for marks adjusted for removed columns */ 1389 less_cols = (int)(p_extra - saved_line); 1390 } 1391 1392 if (p_extra == NULL) 1393 p_extra = (char_u *)""; /* append empty line */ 1394 1395 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 1396 /* concatenate leader and p_extra, if there is a leader */ 1397 if (lead_len) 1398 { 1399 if (flags & OPENLINE_COM_LIST && second_line_indent > 0) 1400 { 1401 int i; 1402 int padding = second_line_indent 1403 - (newindent + (int)STRLEN(leader)); 1404 1405 /* Here whitespace is inserted after the comment char. 1406 * Below, set_indent(newindent, SIN_INSERT) will insert the 1407 * whitespace needed before the comment char. */ 1408 for (i = 0; i < padding; i++) 1409 { 1410 STRCAT(leader, " "); 1411 less_cols--; 1412 newcol++; 1413 } 1414 } 1415 STRCAT(leader, p_extra); 1416 p_extra = leader; 1417 did_ai = TRUE; /* So truncating blanks works with comments */ 1418 less_cols -= lead_len; 1419 } 1420 else 1421 end_comment_pending = NUL; /* turns out there was no leader */ 1422 #endif 1423 1424 old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor; 1425 if (dir == BACKWARD) 1426 --curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 1427 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE 1428 if (!(State & VREPLACE_FLAG) || old_cursor.lnum >= orig_line_count) 1429 #endif 1430 { 1431 if (ml_append(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, p_extra, (colnr_T)0, FALSE) 1432 == FAIL) 1433 goto theend; 1434 /* Postpone calling changed_lines(), because it would mess up folding 1435 * with markers. */ 1436 mark_adjust(curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1, (linenr_T)MAXLNUM, 1L, 0L); 1437 did_append = TRUE; 1438 } 1439 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE 1440 else 1441 { 1442 /* 1443 * In VREPLACE mode we are starting to replace the next line. 1444 */ 1445 curwin->w_cursor.lnum++; 1446 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum >= Insstart.lnum + vr_lines_changed) 1447 { 1448 /* In case we NL to a new line, BS to the previous one, and NL 1449 * again, we don't want to save the new line for undo twice. 1450 */ 1451 (void)u_save_cursor(); /* errors are ignored! */ 1452 vr_lines_changed++; 1453 } 1454 ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, p_extra, TRUE); 1455 changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0); 1456 curwin->w_cursor.lnum--; 1457 did_append = FALSE; 1458 } 1459 #endif 1460 1461 if (newindent 1462 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 1463 || did_si 1464 #endif 1465 ) 1466 { 1467 ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 1468 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 1469 if (did_si) 1470 { 1471 int sw = (int)get_sw_value(curbuf); 1472 1473 if (p_sr) 1474 newindent -= newindent % sw; 1475 newindent += sw; 1476 } 1477 #endif 1478 /* Copy the indent */ 1479 if (curbuf->b_p_ci) 1480 { 1481 (void)copy_indent(newindent, saved_line); 1482 1483 /* 1484 * Set the 'preserveindent' option so that any further screwing 1485 * with the line doesn't entirely destroy our efforts to preserve 1486 * it. It gets restored at the function end. 1487 */ 1488 curbuf->b_p_pi = TRUE; 1489 } 1490 else 1491 (void)set_indent(newindent, SIN_INSERT); 1492 less_cols -= curwin->w_cursor.col; 1493 1494 ai_col = curwin->w_cursor.col; 1495 1496 /* 1497 * In REPLACE mode, for each character in the new indent, there must 1498 * be a NUL on the replace stack, for when it is deleted with BS 1499 */ 1500 if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State)) 1501 for (n = 0; n < (int)curwin->w_cursor.col; ++n) 1502 replace_push(NUL); 1503 newcol += curwin->w_cursor.col; 1504 #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT 1505 if (no_si) 1506 did_si = FALSE; 1507 #endif 1508 } 1509 1510 #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 1511 /* 1512 * In REPLACE mode, for each character in the extra leader, there must be 1513 * a NUL on the replace stack, for when it is deleted with BS. 1514 */ 1515 if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State)) 1516 while (lead_len-- > 0) 1517 replace_push(NUL); 1518 #endif 1519 1520 curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor; 1521 1522 if (dir == FORWARD) 1523 { 1524 if (trunc_line || (State & INSERT)) 1525 { 1526 /* truncate current line at cursor */ 1527 saved_line[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL; 1528 /* Remove trailing white space, unless OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL used. */ 1529 if (trunc_line && !(flags & OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL)) 1530 truncate_spaces(saved_line); 1531 ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, saved_line, FALSE); 1532 saved_line = NULL; 1533 if (did_append) 1534 { 1535 changed_lines(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col, 1536 curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1, 1L); 1537 did_append = FALSE; 1538 1539 /* Move marks after the line break to the new line. */ 1540 if (flags & OPENLINE_MARKFIX) 1541 mark_col_adjust(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 1542 curwin->w_cursor.col + less_cols_off, 1543 1L, (long)-less_cols); 1544 } 1545 else 1546 changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col); 1547 } 1548 1549 /* 1550 * Put the cursor on the new line. Careful: the scrollup() above may 1551 * have moved w_cursor, we must use old_cursor. 1552 */ 1553 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = old_cursor.lnum + 1; 1554 } 1555 if (did_append) 1556 changed_lines(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 1L); 1557 1558 curwin->w_cursor.col = newcol; 1559 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT 1560 curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0; 1561 #endif 1562 1563 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT)) 1564 /* 1565 * In VREPLACE mode, we are handling the replace stack ourselves, so stop 1566 * fixthisline() from doing it (via change_indent()) by telling it we're in 1567 * normal INSERT mode. 1568 */ 1569 if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG) 1570 { 1571 vreplace_mode = State; /* So we know to put things right later */ 1572 State = INSERT; 1573 } 1574 else 1575 vreplace_mode = 0; 1576 #endif 1577 #ifdef FEAT_LISP 1578 /* 1579 * May do lisp indenting. 1580 */ 1581 if (!p_paste 1582 # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS 1583 && leader == NULL 1584 # endif 1585 && curbuf->b_p_lisp 1586 && curbuf->b_p_ai) 1587 { 1588 fixthisline(get_lisp_indent); 1589 p = ml_get_curline(); 1590 ai_col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(p) - p); 1591 } 1592 #endif 1593 #ifdef FEAT_CINDENT 1594 /* 1595 * May do indenting after opening a new line. 1596 */ 1597 if (!p_paste 1598 && (curbuf->b_p_cin 1599 # ifdef FEAT_EVAL 1600 || *curbuf->b_p_inde != NUL 1601 # endif 1602 ) 1603 && in_cinkeys(dir == FORWARD 1604 ? KEY_OPEN_FORW 1605 : KEY_OPEN_BACK, ' ', linewhite(curwin->w_cursor.lnum))) 1606 { 1607 do_c_expr_indent(); 1608 p = ml_get_curline(); 1609 ai_col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(p) - p); 1610 } 1611 #endif 1612 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT)) 1613 if (vreplace_mode != 0) 1614 State = vreplace_mode; 1615 #endif 1616 1617 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE 1618 /* 1619 * Finally, VREPLACE gets the stuff on the new line, then puts back the 1620 * original line, and inserts the new stuff char by char, pushing old stuff 1621 * onto the replace stack (via ins_char()). 1622 */ 1623 if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG) 1624 { 1625 /* Put new line in p_extra */ 1626 p_extra = vim_strsave(ml_get_curline()); 1627 if (p_extra == NULL) 1628 goto theend; 1629 1630 /* Put back original line */ 1631 ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, next_line, FALSE); 1632 1633 /* Insert new stuff into line again */ 1634 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 1635 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT 1636 curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0; 1637 #endif 1638 ins_bytes(p_extra); /* will call changed_bytes() */ 1639 vim_free(p_extra); 1640 next_line = NULL; 1641 } 1642 #endif 1643 1644 retval = TRUE; /* success! */ 1645 theend: 1646 curbuf->b_p_pi = saved_pi; 1647 vim_free(saved_line); 1648 vim_free(next_line); 1649 vim_free(allocated); 1650 return retval; 1651 } 1652 1653 #if defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) || defined(PROTO) 1654 /* 1655 * get_leader_len() returns the length in bytes of the prefix of the given 1656 * string which introduces a comment. If this string is not a comment then 1657 * 0 is returned. 1658 * When "flags" is not NULL, it is set to point to the flags of the recognized 1659 * comment leader. 1660 * "backward" must be true for the "O" command. 1661 * If "include_space" is set, include trailing whitespace while calculating the 1662 * length. 1663 */ 1664 int 1665 get_leader_len(line, flags, backward, include_space) 1666 char_u *line; 1667 char_u **flags; 1668 int backward; 1669 int include_space; 1670 { 1671 int i, j; 1672 int result; 1673 int got_com = FALSE; 1674 int found_one; 1675 char_u part_buf[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* buffer for one option part */ 1676 char_u *string; /* pointer to comment string */ 1677 char_u *list; 1678 int middle_match_len = 0; 1679 char_u *prev_list; 1680 char_u *saved_flags = NULL; 1681 1682 result = i = 0; 1683 while (vim_iswhite(line[i])) /* leading white space is ignored */ 1684 ++i; 1685 1686 /* 1687 * Repeat to match several nested comment strings. 1688 */ 1689 while (line[i] != NUL) 1690 { 1691 /* 1692 * scan through the 'comments' option for a match 1693 */ 1694 found_one = FALSE; 1695 for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; ) 1696 { 1697 /* Get one option part into part_buf[]. Advance "list" to next 1698 * one. Put "string" at start of string. */ 1699 if (!got_com && flags != NULL) 1700 *flags = list; /* remember where flags started */ 1701 prev_list = list; 1702 (void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); 1703 string = vim_strchr(part_buf, ':'); 1704 if (string == NULL) /* missing ':', ignore this part */ 1705 continue; 1706 *string++ = NUL; /* isolate flags from string */ 1707 1708 /* If we found a middle match previously, use that match when this 1709 * is not a middle or end. */ 1710 if (middle_match_len != 0 1711 && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_MIDDLE) == NULL 1712 && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_END) == NULL) 1713 break; 1714 1715 /* When we already found a nested comment, only accept further 1716 * nested comments. */ 1717 if (got_com && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) == NULL) 1718 continue; 1719 1720 /* When 'O' flag present and using "O" command skip this one. */ 1721 if (backward && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NOBACK) != NULL) 1722 continue; 1723 1724 /* Line contents and string must match. 1725 * When string starts with white space, must have some white space 1726 * (but the amount does not need to match, there might be a mix of 1727 * TABs and spaces). */ 1728 if (vim_iswhite(string[0])) 1729 { 1730 if (i == 0 || !vim_iswhite(line[i - 1])) 1731 continue; /* missing white space */ 1732 while (vim_iswhite(string[0])) 1733 ++string; 1734 } 1735 for (j = 0; string[j] != NUL && string[j] == line[i + j]; ++j) 1736 ; 1737 if (string[j] != NUL) 1738 continue; /* string doesn't match */ 1739 1740 /* When 'b' flag used, there must be white space or an 1741 * end-of-line after the string in the line. */ 1742 if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_BLANK) != NULL 1743 && !vim_iswhite(line[i + j]) && line[i + j] != NUL) 1744 continue; 1745 1746 /* We have found a match, stop searching unless this is a middle 1747 * comment. The middle comment can be a substring of the end 1748 * comment in which case it's better to return the length of the 1749 * end comment and its flags. Thus we keep searching with middle 1750 * and end matches and use an end match if it matches better. */ 1751 if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_MIDDLE) != NULL) 1752 { 1753 if (middle_match_len == 0) 1754 { 1755 middle_match_len = j; 1756 saved_flags = prev_list; 1757 } 1758 continue; 1759 } 1760 if (middle_match_len != 0 && j > middle_match_len) 1761 /* Use this match instead of the middle match, since it's a 1762 * longer thus better match. */ 1763 middle_match_len = 0; 1764 1765 if (middle_match_len == 0) 1766 i += j; 1767 found_one = TRUE; 1768 break; 1769 } 1770 1771 if (middle_match_len != 0) 1772 { 1773 /* Use the previously found middle match after failing to find a 1774 * match with an end. */ 1775 if (!got_com && flags != NULL) 1776 *flags = saved_flags; 1777 i += middle_match_len; 1778 found_one = TRUE; 1779 } 1780 1781 /* No match found, stop scanning. */ 1782 if (!found_one) 1783 break; 1784 1785 result = i; 1786 1787 /* Include any trailing white space. */ 1788 while (vim_iswhite(line[i])) 1789 ++i; 1790 1791 if (include_space) 1792 result = i; 1793 1794 /* If this comment doesn't nest, stop here. */ 1795 got_com = TRUE; 1796 if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) == NULL) 1797 break; 1798 } 1799 return result; 1800 } 1801 1802 /* 1803 * Return the offset at which the last comment in line starts. If there is no 1804 * comment in the whole line, -1 is returned. 1805 * 1806 * When "flags" is not null, it is set to point to the flags describing the 1807 * recognized comment leader. 1808 */ 1809 int 1810 get_last_leader_offset(line, flags) 1811 char_u *line; 1812 char_u **flags; 1813 { 1814 int result = -1; 1815 int i, j; 1816 int lower_check_bound = 0; 1817 char_u *string; 1818 char_u *com_leader; 1819 char_u *com_flags; 1820 char_u *list; 1821 int found_one; 1822 char_u part_buf[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* buffer for one option part */ 1823 1824 /* 1825 * Repeat to match several nested comment strings. 1826 */ 1827 i = (int)STRLEN(line); 1828 while (--i >= lower_check_bound) 1829 { 1830 /* 1831 * scan through the 'comments' option for a match 1832 */ 1833 found_one = FALSE; 1834 for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; ) 1835 { 1836 char_u *flags_save = list; 1837 1838 /* 1839 * Get one option part into part_buf[]. Advance list to next one. 1840 * put string at start of string. 1841 */ 1842 (void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); 1843 string = vim_strchr(part_buf, ':'); 1844 if (string == NULL) /* If everything is fine, this cannot actually 1845 * happen. */ 1846 { 1847 continue; 1848 } 1849 *string++ = NUL; /* Isolate flags from string. */ 1850 com_leader = string; 1851 1852 /* 1853 * Line contents and string must match. 1854 * When string starts with white space, must have some white space 1855 * (but the amount does not need to match, there might be a mix of 1856 * TABs and spaces). 1857 */ 1858 if (vim_iswhite(string[0])) 1859 { 1860 if (i == 0 || !vim_iswhite(line[i - 1])) 1861 continue; 1862 while (vim_iswhite(string[0])) 1863 ++string; 1864 } 1865 for (j = 0; string[j] != NUL && string[j] == line[i + j]; ++j) 1866 /* do nothing */; 1867 if (string[j] != NUL) 1868 continue; 1869 1870 /* 1871 * When 'b' flag used, there must be white space or an 1872 * end-of-line after the string in the line. 1873 */ 1874 if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_BLANK) != NULL 1875 && !vim_iswhite(line[i + j]) && line[i + j] != NUL) 1876 { 1877 continue; 1878 } 1879 1880 /* 1881 * We have found a match, stop searching. 1882 */ 1883 found_one = TRUE; 1884 1885 if (flags) 1886 *flags = flags_save; 1887 com_flags = flags_save; 1888 1889 break; 1890 } 1891 1892 if (found_one) 1893 { 1894 char_u part_buf2[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* buffer for one option part */ 1895 int len1, len2, off; 1896 1897 result = i; 1898 /* 1899 * If this comment nests, continue searching. 1900 */ 1901 if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) != NULL) 1902 continue; 1903 1904 lower_check_bound = i; 1905 1906 /* Let's verify whether the comment leader found is a substring 1907 * of other comment leaders. If it is, let's adjust the 1908 * lower_check_bound so that we make sure that we have determined 1909 * the comment leader correctly. 1910 */ 1911 1912 while (vim_iswhite(*com_leader)) 1913 ++com_leader; 1914 len1 = (int)STRLEN(com_leader); 1915 1916 for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; ) 1917 { 1918 char_u *flags_save = list; 1919 1920 (void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf2, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); 1921 if (flags_save == com_flags) 1922 continue; 1923 string = vim_strchr(part_buf2, ':'); 1924 ++string; 1925 while (vim_iswhite(*string)) 1926 ++string; 1927 len2 = (int)STRLEN(string); 1928 if (len2 == 0) 1929 continue; 1930 1931 /* Now we have to verify whether string ends with a substring 1932 * beginning the com_leader. */ 1933 for (off = (len2 > i ? i : len2); off > 0 && off + len1 > len2;) 1934 { 1935 --off; 1936 if (!STRNCMP(string + off, com_leader, len2 - off)) 1937 { 1938 if (i - off < lower_check_bound) 1939 lower_check_bound = i - off; 1940 } 1941 } 1942 } 1943 } 1944 } 1945 return result; 1946 } 1947 #endif 1948 1949 /* 1950 * Return the number of window lines occupied by buffer line "lnum". 1951 */ 1952 int 1953 plines(lnum) 1954 linenr_T lnum; 1955 { 1956 return plines_win(curwin, lnum, TRUE); 1957 } 1958 1959 int 1960 plines_win(wp, lnum, winheight) 1961 win_T *wp; 1962 linenr_T lnum; 1963 int winheight; /* when TRUE limit to window height */ 1964 { 1965 #if defined(FEAT_DIFF) || defined(PROTO) 1966 /* Check for filler lines above this buffer line. When folded the result 1967 * is one line anyway. */ 1968 return plines_win_nofill(wp, lnum, winheight) + diff_check_fill(wp, lnum); 1969 } 1970 1971 int 1972 plines_nofill(lnum) 1973 linenr_T lnum; 1974 { 1975 return plines_win_nofill(curwin, lnum, TRUE); 1976 } 1977 1978 int 1979 plines_win_nofill(wp, lnum, winheight) 1980 win_T *wp; 1981 linenr_T lnum; 1982 int winheight; /* when TRUE limit to window height */ 1983 { 1984 #endif 1985 int lines; 1986 1987 if (!wp->w_p_wrap) 1988 return 1; 1989 1990 #ifdef FEAT_VERTSPLIT 1991 if (wp->w_width == 0) 1992 return 1; 1993 #endif 1994 1995 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING 1996 /* A folded lines is handled just like an empty line. */ 1997 /* NOTE: Caller must handle lines that are MAYBE folded. */ 1998 if (lineFolded(wp, lnum) == TRUE) 1999 return 1; 2000 #endif 2001 2002 lines = plines_win_nofold(wp, lnum); 2003 if (winheight > 0 && lines > wp->w_height) 2004 return (int)wp->w_height; 2005 return lines; 2006 } 2007 2008 /* 2009 * Return number of window lines physical line "lnum" will occupy in window 2010 * "wp". Does not care about folding, 'wrap' or 'diff'. 2011 */ 2012 int 2013 plines_win_nofold(wp, lnum) 2014 win_T *wp; 2015 linenr_T lnum; 2016 { 2017 char_u *s; 2018 long col; 2019 int width; 2020 2021 s = ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum, FALSE); 2022 if (*s == NUL) /* empty line */ 2023 return 1; 2024 col = win_linetabsize(wp, s, (colnr_T)MAXCOL); 2025 2026 /* 2027 * If list mode is on, then the '$' at the end of the line may take up one 2028 * extra column. 2029 */ 2030 if (wp->w_p_list && lcs_eol != NUL) 2031 col += 1; 2032 2033 /* 2034 * Add column offset for 'number', 'relativenumber' and 'foldcolumn'. 2035 */ 2036 width = W_WIDTH(wp) - win_col_off(wp); 2037 if (width <= 0) 2038 return 32000; 2039 if (col <= width) 2040 return 1; 2041 col -= width; 2042 width += win_col_off2(wp); 2043 return (col + (width - 1)) / width + 1; 2044 } 2045 2046 /* 2047 * Like plines_win(), but only reports the number of physical screen lines 2048 * used from the start of the line to the given column number. 2049 */ 2050 int 2051 plines_win_col(wp, lnum, column) 2052 win_T *wp; 2053 linenr_T lnum; 2054 long column; 2055 { 2056 long col; 2057 char_u *s; 2058 int lines = 0; 2059 int width; 2060 char_u *line; 2061 2062 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF 2063 /* Check for filler lines above this buffer line. When folded the result 2064 * is one line anyway. */ 2065 lines = diff_check_fill(wp, lnum); 2066 #endif 2067 2068 if (!wp->w_p_wrap) 2069 return lines + 1; 2070 2071 #ifdef FEAT_VERTSPLIT 2072 if (wp->w_width == 0) 2073 return lines + 1; 2074 #endif 2075 2076 line = s = ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum, FALSE); 2077 2078 col = 0; 2079 while (*s != NUL && --column >= 0) 2080 { 2081 col += win_lbr_chartabsize(wp, line, s, (colnr_T)col, NULL); 2082 mb_ptr_adv(s); 2083 } 2084 2085 /* 2086 * If *s is a TAB, and the TAB is not displayed as ^I, and we're not in 2087 * INSERT mode, then col must be adjusted so that it represents the last 2088 * screen position of the TAB. This only fixes an error when the TAB wraps 2089 * from one screen line to the next (when 'columns' is not a multiple of 2090 * 'ts') -- webb. 2091 */ 2092 if (*s == TAB && (State & NORMAL) && (!wp->w_p_list || lcs_tab1)) 2093 col += win_lbr_chartabsize(wp, line, s, (colnr_T)col, NULL) - 1; 2094 2095 /* 2096 * Add column offset for 'number', 'relativenumber', 'foldcolumn', etc. 2097 */ 2098 width = W_WIDTH(wp) - win_col_off(wp); 2099 if (width <= 0) 2100 return 9999; 2101 2102 lines += 1; 2103 if (col > width) 2104 lines += (col - width) / (width + win_col_off2(wp)) + 1; 2105 return lines; 2106 } 2107 2108 int 2109 plines_m_win(wp, first, last) 2110 win_T *wp; 2111 linenr_T first, last; 2112 { 2113 int count = 0; 2114 2115 while (first <= last) 2116 { 2117 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING 2118 int x; 2119 2120 /* Check if there are any really folded lines, but also included lines 2121 * that are maybe folded. */ 2122 x = foldedCount(wp, first, NULL); 2123 if (x > 0) 2124 { 2125 ++count; /* count 1 for "+-- folded" line */ 2126 first += x; 2127 } 2128 else 2129 #endif 2130 { 2131 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF 2132 if (first == wp->w_topline) 2133 count += plines_win_nofill(wp, first, TRUE) + wp->w_topfill; 2134 else 2135 #endif 2136 count += plines_win(wp, first, TRUE); 2137 ++first; 2138 } 2139 } 2140 return (count); 2141 } 2142 2143 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_INS_EXPAND) || defined(PROTO) 2144 /* 2145 * Insert string "p" at the cursor position. Stops at a NUL byte. 2146 * Handles Replace mode and multi-byte characters. 2147 */ 2148 void 2149 ins_bytes(p) 2150 char_u *p; 2151 { 2152 ins_bytes_len(p, (int)STRLEN(p)); 2153 } 2154 #endif 2155 2156 #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_INS_EXPAND) \ 2157 || defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) || defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO) 2158 /* 2159 * Insert string "p" with length "len" at the cursor position. 2160 * Handles Replace mode and multi-byte characters. 2161 */ 2162 void 2163 ins_bytes_len(p, len) 2164 char_u *p; 2165 int len; 2166 { 2167 int i; 2168 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2169 int n; 2170 2171 if (has_mbyte) 2172 for (i = 0; i < len; i += n) 2173 { 2174 if (enc_utf8) 2175 /* avoid reading past p[len] */ 2176 n = utfc_ptr2len_len(p + i, len - i); 2177 else 2178 n = (*mb_ptr2len)(p + i); 2179 ins_char_bytes(p + i, n); 2180 } 2181 else 2182 # endif 2183 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i) 2184 ins_char(p[i]); 2185 } 2186 #endif 2187 2188 /* 2189 * Insert or replace a single character at the cursor position. 2190 * When in REPLACE or VREPLACE mode, replace any existing character. 2191 * Caller must have prepared for undo. 2192 * For multi-byte characters we get the whole character, the caller must 2193 * convert bytes to a character. 2194 */ 2195 void 2196 ins_char(c) 2197 int c; 2198 { 2199 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO) 2200 char_u buf[MB_MAXBYTES + 1]; 2201 int n; 2202 2203 n = (*mb_char2bytes)(c, buf); 2204 2205 /* When "c" is 0x100, 0x200, etc. we don't want to insert a NUL byte. 2206 * Happens for CTRL-Vu9900. */ 2207 if (buf[0] == 0) 2208 buf[0] = '\n'; 2209 2210 ins_char_bytes(buf, n); 2211 } 2212 2213 void 2214 ins_char_bytes(buf, charlen) 2215 char_u *buf; 2216 int charlen; 2217 { 2218 int c = buf[0]; 2219 #endif 2220 int newlen; /* nr of bytes inserted */ 2221 int oldlen; /* nr of bytes deleted (0 when not replacing) */ 2222 char_u *p; 2223 char_u *newp; 2224 char_u *oldp; 2225 int linelen; /* length of old line including NUL */ 2226 colnr_T col; 2227 linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 2228 int i; 2229 2230 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT 2231 /* Break tabs if needed. */ 2232 if (virtual_active() && curwin->w_cursor.coladd > 0) 2233 coladvance_force(getviscol()); 2234 #endif 2235 2236 col = curwin->w_cursor.col; 2237 oldp = ml_get(lnum); 2238 linelen = (int)STRLEN(oldp) + 1; 2239 2240 /* The lengths default to the values for when not replacing. */ 2241 oldlen = 0; 2242 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2243 newlen = charlen; 2244 #else 2245 newlen = 1; 2246 #endif 2247 2248 if (State & REPLACE_FLAG) 2249 { 2250 #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE 2251 if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG) 2252 { 2253 colnr_T new_vcol = 0; /* init for GCC */ 2254 colnr_T vcol; 2255 int old_list; 2256 #ifndef FEAT_MBYTE 2257 char_u buf[2]; 2258 #endif 2259 2260 /* 2261 * Disable 'list' temporarily, unless 'cpo' contains the 'L' flag. 2262 * Returns the old value of list, so when finished, 2263 * curwin->w_p_list should be set back to this. 2264 */ 2265 old_list = curwin->w_p_list; 2266 if (old_list && vim_strchr(p_cpo, CPO_LISTWM) == NULL) 2267 curwin->w_p_list = FALSE; 2268 2269 /* 2270 * In virtual replace mode each character may replace one or more 2271 * characters (zero if it's a TAB). Count the number of bytes to 2272 * be deleted to make room for the new character, counting screen 2273 * cells. May result in adding spaces to fill a gap. 2274 */ 2275 getvcol(curwin, &curwin->w_cursor, NULL, &vcol, NULL); 2276 #ifndef FEAT_MBYTE 2277 buf[0] = c; 2278 buf[1] = NUL; 2279 #endif 2280 new_vcol = vcol + chartabsize(buf, vcol); 2281 while (oldp[col + oldlen] != NUL && vcol < new_vcol) 2282 { 2283 vcol += chartabsize(oldp + col + oldlen, vcol); 2284 /* Don't need to remove a TAB that takes us to the right 2285 * position. */ 2286 if (vcol > new_vcol && oldp[col + oldlen] == TAB) 2287 break; 2288 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2289 oldlen += (*mb_ptr2len)(oldp + col + oldlen); 2290 #else 2291 ++oldlen; 2292 #endif 2293 /* Deleted a bit too much, insert spaces. */ 2294 if (vcol > new_vcol) 2295 newlen += vcol - new_vcol; 2296 } 2297 curwin->w_p_list = old_list; 2298 } 2299 else 2300 #endif 2301 if (oldp[col] != NUL) 2302 { 2303 /* normal replace */ 2304 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2305 oldlen = (*mb_ptr2len)(oldp + col); 2306 #else 2307 oldlen = 1; 2308 #endif 2309 } 2310 2311 2312 /* Push the replaced bytes onto the replace stack, so that they can be 2313 * put back when BS is used. The bytes of a multi-byte character are 2314 * done the other way around, so that the first byte is popped off 2315 * first (it tells the byte length of the character). */ 2316 replace_push(NUL); 2317 for (i = 0; i < oldlen; ++i) 2318 { 2319 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2320 if (has_mbyte) 2321 i += replace_push_mb(oldp + col + i) - 1; 2322 else 2323 #endif 2324 replace_push(oldp[col + i]); 2325 } 2326 } 2327 2328 newp = alloc_check((unsigned)(linelen + newlen - oldlen)); 2329 if (newp == NULL) 2330 return; 2331 2332 /* Copy bytes before the cursor. */ 2333 if (col > 0) 2334 mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col); 2335 2336 /* Copy bytes after the changed character(s). */ 2337 p = newp + col; 2338 mch_memmove(p + newlen, oldp + col + oldlen, 2339 (size_t)(linelen - col - oldlen)); 2340 2341 /* Insert or overwrite the new character. */ 2342 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2343 mch_memmove(p, buf, charlen); 2344 i = charlen; 2345 #else 2346 *p = c; 2347 i = 1; 2348 #endif 2349 2350 /* Fill with spaces when necessary. */ 2351 while (i < newlen) 2352 p[i++] = ' '; 2353 2354 /* Replace the line in the buffer. */ 2355 ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE); 2356 2357 /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */ 2358 changed_bytes(lnum, col); 2359 2360 /* 2361 * If we're in Insert or Replace mode and 'showmatch' is set, then briefly 2362 * show the match for right parens and braces. 2363 */ 2364 if (p_sm && (State & INSERT) 2365 && msg_silent == 0 2366 #ifdef FEAT_INS_EXPAND 2367 && !ins_compl_active() 2368 #endif 2369 ) 2370 { 2371 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2372 if (has_mbyte) 2373 showmatch(mb_ptr2char(buf)); 2374 else 2375 #endif 2376 showmatch(c); 2377 } 2378 2379 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT 2380 if (!p_ri || (State & REPLACE_FLAG)) 2381 #endif 2382 { 2383 /* Normal insert: move cursor right */ 2384 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2385 curwin->w_cursor.col += charlen; 2386 #else 2387 ++curwin->w_cursor.col; 2388 #endif 2389 } 2390 /* 2391 * TODO: should try to update w_row here, to avoid recomputing it later. 2392 */ 2393 } 2394 2395 /* 2396 * Insert a string at the cursor position. 2397 * Note: Does NOT handle Replace mode. 2398 * Caller must have prepared for undo. 2399 */ 2400 void 2401 ins_str(s) 2402 char_u *s; 2403 { 2404 char_u *oldp, *newp; 2405 int newlen = (int)STRLEN(s); 2406 int oldlen; 2407 colnr_T col; 2408 linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 2409 2410 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT 2411 if (virtual_active() && curwin->w_cursor.coladd > 0) 2412 coladvance_force(getviscol()); 2413 #endif 2414 2415 col = curwin->w_cursor.col; 2416 oldp = ml_get(lnum); 2417 oldlen = (int)STRLEN(oldp); 2418 2419 newp = alloc_check((unsigned)(oldlen + newlen + 1)); 2420 if (newp == NULL) 2421 return; 2422 if (col > 0) 2423 mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col); 2424 mch_memmove(newp + col, s, (size_t)newlen); 2425 mch_memmove(newp + col + newlen, oldp + col, (size_t)(oldlen - col + 1)); 2426 ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE); 2427 changed_bytes(lnum, col); 2428 curwin->w_cursor.col += newlen; 2429 } 2430 2431 /* 2432 * Delete one character under the cursor. 2433 * If "fixpos" is TRUE, don't leave the cursor on the NUL after the line. 2434 * Caller must have prepared for undo. 2435 * 2436 * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise 2437 */ 2438 int 2439 del_char(fixpos) 2440 int fixpos; 2441 { 2442 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2443 if (has_mbyte) 2444 { 2445 /* Make sure the cursor is at the start of a character. */ 2446 mb_adjust_cursor(); 2447 if (*ml_get_cursor() == NUL) 2448 return FAIL; 2449 return del_chars(1L, fixpos); 2450 } 2451 #endif 2452 return del_bytes(1L, fixpos, TRUE); 2453 } 2454 2455 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO) 2456 /* 2457 * Like del_bytes(), but delete characters instead of bytes. 2458 */ 2459 int 2460 del_chars(count, fixpos) 2461 long count; 2462 int fixpos; 2463 { 2464 long bytes = 0; 2465 long i; 2466 char_u *p; 2467 int l; 2468 2469 p = ml_get_cursor(); 2470 for (i = 0; i < count && *p != NUL; ++i) 2471 { 2472 l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p); 2473 bytes += l; 2474 p += l; 2475 } 2476 return del_bytes(bytes, fixpos, TRUE); 2477 } 2478 #endif 2479 2480 /* 2481 * Delete "count" bytes under the cursor. 2482 * If "fixpos" is TRUE, don't leave the cursor on the NUL after the line. 2483 * Caller must have prepared for undo. 2484 * 2485 * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise 2486 */ 2487 int 2488 del_bytes(count, fixpos_arg, use_delcombine) 2489 long count; 2490 int fixpos_arg; 2491 int use_delcombine UNUSED; /* 'delcombine' option applies */ 2492 { 2493 char_u *oldp, *newp; 2494 colnr_T oldlen; 2495 linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 2496 colnr_T col = curwin->w_cursor.col; 2497 int was_alloced; 2498 long movelen; 2499 int fixpos = fixpos_arg; 2500 2501 oldp = ml_get(lnum); 2502 oldlen = (int)STRLEN(oldp); 2503 2504 /* 2505 * Can't do anything when the cursor is on the NUL after the line. 2506 */ 2507 if (col >= oldlen) 2508 return FAIL; 2509 2510 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2511 /* If 'delcombine' is set and deleting (less than) one character, only 2512 * delete the last combining character. */ 2513 if (p_deco && use_delcombine && enc_utf8 2514 && utfc_ptr2len(oldp + col) >= count) 2515 { 2516 int cc[MAX_MCO]; 2517 int n; 2518 2519 (void)utfc_ptr2char(oldp + col, cc); 2520 if (cc[0] != NUL) 2521 { 2522 /* Find the last composing char, there can be several. */ 2523 n = col; 2524 do 2525 { 2526 col = n; 2527 count = utf_ptr2len(oldp + n); 2528 n += count; 2529 } while (UTF_COMPOSINGLIKE(oldp + col, oldp + n)); 2530 fixpos = 0; 2531 } 2532 } 2533 #endif 2534 2535 /* 2536 * When count is too big, reduce it. 2537 */ 2538 movelen = (long)oldlen - (long)col - count + 1; /* includes trailing NUL */ 2539 if (movelen <= 1) 2540 { 2541 /* 2542 * If we just took off the last character of a non-blank line, and 2543 * fixpos is TRUE, we don't want to end up positioned at the NUL, 2544 * unless "restart_edit" is set or 'virtualedit' contains "onemore". 2545 */ 2546 if (col > 0 && fixpos && restart_edit == 0 2547 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT 2548 && (ve_flags & VE_ONEMORE) == 0 2549 #endif 2550 ) 2551 { 2552 --curwin->w_cursor.col; 2553 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT 2554 curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0; 2555 #endif 2556 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2557 if (has_mbyte) 2558 curwin->w_cursor.col -= 2559 (*mb_head_off)(oldp, oldp + curwin->w_cursor.col); 2560 #endif 2561 } 2562 count = oldlen - col; 2563 movelen = 1; 2564 } 2565 2566 /* 2567 * If the old line has been allocated the deletion can be done in the 2568 * existing line. Otherwise a new line has to be allocated 2569 * Can't do this when using Netbeans, because we would need to invoke 2570 * netbeans_removed(), which deallocates the line. Let ml_replace() take 2571 * care of notifying Netbeans. 2572 */ 2573 #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG 2574 if (netbeans_active()) 2575 was_alloced = FALSE; 2576 else 2577 #endif 2578 was_alloced = ml_line_alloced(); /* check if oldp was allocated */ 2579 if (was_alloced) 2580 newp = oldp; /* use same allocated memory */ 2581 else 2582 { /* need to allocate a new line */ 2583 newp = alloc((unsigned)(oldlen + 1 - count)); 2584 if (newp == NULL) 2585 return FAIL; 2586 mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col); 2587 } 2588 mch_memmove(newp + col, oldp + col + count, (size_t)movelen); 2589 if (!was_alloced) 2590 ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE); 2591 2592 /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */ 2593 changed_bytes(lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col); 2594 2595 return OK; 2596 } 2597 2598 /* 2599 * Delete from cursor to end of line. 2600 * Caller must have prepared for undo. 2601 * 2602 * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise 2603 */ 2604 int 2605 truncate_line(fixpos) 2606 int fixpos; /* if TRUE fix the cursor position when done */ 2607 { 2608 char_u *newp; 2609 linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 2610 colnr_T col = curwin->w_cursor.col; 2611 2612 if (col == 0) 2613 newp = vim_strsave((char_u *)""); 2614 else 2615 newp = vim_strnsave(ml_get(lnum), col); 2616 2617 if (newp == NULL) 2618 return FAIL; 2619 2620 ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE); 2621 2622 /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */ 2623 changed_bytes(lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col); 2624 2625 /* 2626 * If "fixpos" is TRUE we don't want to end up positioned at the NUL. 2627 */ 2628 if (fixpos && curwin->w_cursor.col > 0) 2629 --curwin->w_cursor.col; 2630 2631 return OK; 2632 } 2633 2634 /* 2635 * Delete "nlines" lines at the cursor. 2636 * Saves the lines for undo first if "undo" is TRUE. 2637 */ 2638 void 2639 del_lines(nlines, undo) 2640 long nlines; /* number of lines to delete */ 2641 int undo; /* if TRUE, prepare for undo */ 2642 { 2643 long n; 2644 linenr_T first = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 2645 2646 if (nlines <= 0) 2647 return; 2648 2649 /* save the deleted lines for undo */ 2650 if (undo && u_savedel(first, nlines) == FAIL) 2651 return; 2652 2653 for (n = 0; n < nlines; ) 2654 { 2655 if (curbuf->b_ml.ml_flags & ML_EMPTY) /* nothing to delete */ 2656 break; 2657 2658 ml_delete(first, TRUE); 2659 ++n; 2660 2661 /* If we delete the last line in the file, stop */ 2662 if (first > curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) 2663 break; 2664 } 2665 2666 /* Correct the cursor position before calling deleted_lines_mark(), it may 2667 * trigger a callback to display the cursor. */ 2668 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 2669 check_cursor_lnum(); 2670 2671 /* adjust marks, mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */ 2672 deleted_lines_mark(first, n); 2673 } 2674 2675 int 2676 gchar_pos(pos) 2677 pos_T *pos; 2678 { 2679 char_u *ptr = ml_get_pos(pos); 2680 2681 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2682 if (has_mbyte) 2683 return (*mb_ptr2char)(ptr); 2684 #endif 2685 return (int)*ptr; 2686 } 2687 2688 int 2689 gchar_cursor() 2690 { 2691 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 2692 if (has_mbyte) 2693 return (*mb_ptr2char)(ml_get_cursor()); 2694 #endif 2695 return (int)*ml_get_cursor(); 2696 } 2697 2698 /* 2699 * Write a character at the current cursor position. 2700 * It is directly written into the block. 2701 */ 2702 void 2703 pchar_cursor(c) 2704 int c; 2705 { 2706 *(ml_get_buf(curbuf, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, TRUE) 2707 + curwin->w_cursor.col) = c; 2708 } 2709 2710 /* 2711 * When extra == 0: Return TRUE if the cursor is before or on the first 2712 * non-blank in the line. 2713 * When extra == 1: Return TRUE if the cursor is before the first non-blank in 2714 * the line. 2715 */ 2716 int 2717 inindent(extra) 2718 int extra; 2719 { 2720 char_u *ptr; 2721 colnr_T col; 2722 2723 for (col = 0, ptr = ml_get_curline(); vim_iswhite(*ptr); ++col) 2724 ++ptr; 2725 if (col >= curwin->w_cursor.col + extra) 2726 return TRUE; 2727 else 2728 return FALSE; 2729 } 2730 2731 /* 2732 * Skip to next part of an option argument: Skip space and comma. 2733 */ 2734 char_u * 2735 skip_to_option_part(p) 2736 char_u *p; 2737 { 2738 if (*p == ',') 2739 ++p; 2740 while (*p == ' ') 2741 ++p; 2742 return p; 2743 } 2744 2745 /* 2746 * Call this function when something in the current buffer is changed. 2747 * 2748 * Most often called through changed_bytes() and changed_lines(), which also 2749 * mark the area of the display to be redrawn. 2750 * 2751 * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. 2752 */ 2753 void 2754 changed() 2755 { 2756 #if defined(FEAT_XIM) && defined(FEAT_GUI_GTK) 2757 /* The text of the preediting area is inserted, but this doesn't 2758 * mean a change of the buffer yet. That is delayed until the 2759 * text is committed. (this means preedit becomes empty) */ 2760 if (im_is_preediting() && !xim_changed_while_preediting) 2761 return; 2762 xim_changed_while_preediting = FALSE; 2763 #endif 2764 2765 if (!curbuf->b_changed) 2766 { 2767 int save_msg_scroll = msg_scroll; 2768 2769 /* Give a warning about changing a read-only file. This may also 2770 * check-out the file, thus change "curbuf"! */ 2771 change_warning(0); 2772 2773 /* Create a swap file if that is wanted. 2774 * Don't do this for "nofile" and "nowrite" buffer types. */ 2775 if (curbuf->b_may_swap 2776 #ifdef FEAT_QUICKFIX 2777 && !bt_dontwrite(curbuf) 2778 #endif 2779 ) 2780 { 2781 ml_open_file(curbuf); 2782 2783 /* The ml_open_file() can cause an ATTENTION message. 2784 * Wait two seconds, to make sure the user reads this unexpected 2785 * message. Since we could be anywhere, call wait_return() now, 2786 * and don't let the emsg() set msg_scroll. */ 2787 if (need_wait_return && emsg_silent == 0) 2788 { 2789 out_flush(); 2790 ui_delay(2000L, TRUE); 2791 wait_return(TRUE); 2792 msg_scroll = save_msg_scroll; 2793 } 2794 } 2795 changed_int(); 2796 } 2797 ++curbuf->b_changedtick; 2798 } 2799 2800 /* 2801 * Internal part of changed(), no user interaction. 2802 */ 2803 void 2804 changed_int() 2805 { 2806 curbuf->b_changed = TRUE; 2807 ml_setflags(curbuf); 2808 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS 2809 check_status(curbuf); 2810 redraw_tabline = TRUE; 2811 #endif 2812 #ifdef FEAT_TITLE 2813 need_maketitle = TRUE; /* set window title later */ 2814 #endif 2815 } 2816 2817 static void changedOneline __ARGS((buf_T *buf, linenr_T lnum)); 2818 static void changed_lines_buf __ARGS((buf_T *buf, linenr_T lnum, linenr_T lnume, long xtra)); 2819 static void changed_common __ARGS((linenr_T lnum, colnr_T col, linenr_T lnume, long xtra)); 2820 2821 /* 2822 * Changed bytes within a single line for the current buffer. 2823 * - marks the windows on this buffer to be redisplayed 2824 * - marks the buffer changed by calling changed() 2825 * - invalidates cached values 2826 * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. 2827 */ 2828 void 2829 changed_bytes(lnum, col) 2830 linenr_T lnum; 2831 colnr_T col; 2832 { 2833 changedOneline(curbuf, lnum); 2834 changed_common(lnum, col, lnum + 1, 0L); 2835 2836 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF 2837 /* Diff highlighting in other diff windows may need to be updated too. */ 2838 if (curwin->w_p_diff) 2839 { 2840 win_T *wp; 2841 linenr_T wlnum; 2842 2843 for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next) 2844 if (wp->w_p_diff && wp != curwin) 2845 { 2846 redraw_win_later(wp, VALID); 2847 wlnum = diff_lnum_win(lnum, wp); 2848 if (wlnum > 0) 2849 changedOneline(wp->w_buffer, wlnum); 2850 } 2851 } 2852 #endif 2853 } 2854 2855 static void 2856 changedOneline(buf, lnum) 2857 buf_T *buf; 2858 linenr_T lnum; 2859 { 2860 if (buf->b_mod_set) 2861 { 2862 /* find the maximum area that must be redisplayed */ 2863 if (lnum < buf->b_mod_top) 2864 buf->b_mod_top = lnum; 2865 else if (lnum >= buf->b_mod_bot) 2866 buf->b_mod_bot = lnum + 1; 2867 } 2868 else 2869 { 2870 /* set the area that must be redisplayed to one line */ 2871 buf->b_mod_set = TRUE; 2872 buf->b_mod_top = lnum; 2873 buf->b_mod_bot = lnum + 1; 2874 buf->b_mod_xlines = 0; 2875 } 2876 } 2877 2878 /* 2879 * Appended "count" lines below line "lnum" in the current buffer. 2880 * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust(). 2881 * Takes care of marking the buffer to be redrawn and sets the changed flag. 2882 */ 2883 void 2884 appended_lines(lnum, count) 2885 linenr_T lnum; 2886 long count; 2887 { 2888 changed_lines(lnum + 1, 0, lnum + 1, count); 2889 } 2890 2891 /* 2892 * Like appended_lines(), but adjust marks first. 2893 */ 2894 void 2895 appended_lines_mark(lnum, count) 2896 linenr_T lnum; 2897 long count; 2898 { 2899 mark_adjust(lnum + 1, (linenr_T)MAXLNUM, count, 0L); 2900 changed_lines(lnum + 1, 0, lnum + 1, count); 2901 } 2902 2903 /* 2904 * Deleted "count" lines at line "lnum" in the current buffer. 2905 * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust(). 2906 * Takes care of marking the buffer to be redrawn and sets the changed flag. 2907 */ 2908 void 2909 deleted_lines(lnum, count) 2910 linenr_T lnum; 2911 long count; 2912 { 2913 changed_lines(lnum, 0, lnum + count, -count); 2914 } 2915 2916 /* 2917 * Like deleted_lines(), but adjust marks first. 2918 * Make sure the cursor is on a valid line before calling, a GUI callback may 2919 * be triggered to display the cursor. 2920 */ 2921 void 2922 deleted_lines_mark(lnum, count) 2923 linenr_T lnum; 2924 long count; 2925 { 2926 mark_adjust(lnum, (linenr_T)(lnum + count - 1), (long)MAXLNUM, -count); 2927 changed_lines(lnum, 0, lnum + count, -count); 2928 } 2929 2930 /* 2931 * Changed lines for the current buffer. 2932 * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust(). 2933 * - mark the buffer changed by calling changed() 2934 * - mark the windows on this buffer to be redisplayed 2935 * - invalidate cached values 2936 * "lnum" is the first line that needs displaying, "lnume" the first line 2937 * below the changed lines (BEFORE the change). 2938 * When only inserting lines, "lnum" and "lnume" are equal. 2939 * Takes care of calling changed() and updating b_mod_*. 2940 * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. 2941 */ 2942 void 2943 changed_lines(lnum, col, lnume, xtra) 2944 linenr_T lnum; /* first line with change */ 2945 colnr_T col; /* column in first line with change */ 2946 linenr_T lnume; /* line below last changed line */ 2947 long xtra; /* number of extra lines (negative when deleting) */ 2948 { 2949 changed_lines_buf(curbuf, lnum, lnume, xtra); 2950 2951 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF 2952 if (xtra == 0 && curwin->w_p_diff) 2953 { 2954 /* When the number of lines doesn't change then mark_adjust() isn't 2955 * called and other diff buffers still need to be marked for 2956 * displaying. */ 2957 win_T *wp; 2958 linenr_T wlnum; 2959 2960 for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next) 2961 if (wp->w_p_diff && wp != curwin) 2962 { 2963 redraw_win_later(wp, VALID); 2964 wlnum = diff_lnum_win(lnum, wp); 2965 if (wlnum > 0) 2966 changed_lines_buf(wp->w_buffer, wlnum, 2967 lnume - lnum + wlnum, 0L); 2968 } 2969 } 2970 #endif 2971 2972 changed_common(lnum, col, lnume, xtra); 2973 } 2974 2975 static void 2976 changed_lines_buf(buf, lnum, lnume, xtra) 2977 buf_T *buf; 2978 linenr_T lnum; /* first line with change */ 2979 linenr_T lnume; /* line below last changed line */ 2980 long xtra; /* number of extra lines (negative when deleting) */ 2981 { 2982 if (buf->b_mod_set) 2983 { 2984 /* find the maximum area that must be redisplayed */ 2985 if (lnum < buf->b_mod_top) 2986 buf->b_mod_top = lnum; 2987 if (lnum < buf->b_mod_bot) 2988 { 2989 /* adjust old bot position for xtra lines */ 2990 buf->b_mod_bot += xtra; 2991 if (buf->b_mod_bot < lnum) 2992 buf->b_mod_bot = lnum; 2993 } 2994 if (lnume + xtra > buf->b_mod_bot) 2995 buf->b_mod_bot = lnume + xtra; 2996 buf->b_mod_xlines += xtra; 2997 } 2998 else 2999 { 3000 /* set the area that must be redisplayed */ 3001 buf->b_mod_set = TRUE; 3002 buf->b_mod_top = lnum; 3003 buf->b_mod_bot = lnume + xtra; 3004 buf->b_mod_xlines = xtra; 3005 } 3006 } 3007 3008 /* 3009 * Common code for when a change is was made. 3010 * See changed_lines() for the arguments. 3011 * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. 3012 */ 3013 static void 3014 changed_common(lnum, col, lnume, xtra) 3015 linenr_T lnum; 3016 colnr_T col; 3017 linenr_T lnume; 3018 long xtra; 3019 { 3020 win_T *wp; 3021 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS 3022 tabpage_T *tp; 3023 #endif 3024 int i; 3025 #ifdef FEAT_JUMPLIST 3026 int cols; 3027 pos_T *p; 3028 int add; 3029 #endif 3030 3031 /* mark the buffer as modified */ 3032 changed(); 3033 3034 /* set the '. mark */ 3035 if (!cmdmod.keepjumps) 3036 { 3037 curbuf->b_last_change.lnum = lnum; 3038 curbuf->b_last_change.col = col; 3039 3040 #ifdef FEAT_JUMPLIST 3041 /* Create a new entry if a new undo-able change was started or we 3042 * don't have an entry yet. */ 3043 if (curbuf->b_new_change || curbuf->b_changelistlen == 0) 3044 { 3045 if (curbuf->b_changelistlen == 0) 3046 add = TRUE; 3047 else 3048 { 3049 /* Don't create a new entry when the line number is the same 3050 * as the last one and the column is not too far away. Avoids 3051 * creating many entries for typing "xxxxx". */ 3052 p = &curbuf->b_changelist[curbuf->b_changelistlen - 1]; 3053 if (p->lnum != lnum) 3054 add = TRUE; 3055 else 3056 { 3057 cols = comp_textwidth(FALSE); 3058 if (cols == 0) 3059 cols = 79; 3060 add = (p->col + cols < col || col + cols < p->col); 3061 } 3062 } 3063 if (add) 3064 { 3065 /* This is the first of a new sequence of undo-able changes 3066 * and it's at some distance of the last change. Use a new 3067 * position in the changelist. */ 3068 curbuf->b_new_change = FALSE; 3069 3070 if (curbuf->b_changelistlen == JUMPLISTSIZE) 3071 { 3072 /* changelist is full: remove oldest entry */ 3073 curbuf->b_changelistlen = JUMPLISTSIZE - 1; 3074 mch_memmove(curbuf->b_changelist, curbuf->b_changelist + 1, 3075 sizeof(pos_T) * (JUMPLISTSIZE - 1)); 3076 FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp) 3077 { 3078 /* Correct position in changelist for other windows on 3079 * this buffer. */ 3080 if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf && wp->w_changelistidx > 0) 3081 --wp->w_changelistidx; 3082 } 3083 } 3084 FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp) 3085 { 3086 /* For other windows, if the position in the changelist is 3087 * at the end it stays at the end. */ 3088 if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf 3089 && wp->w_changelistidx == curbuf->b_changelistlen) 3090 ++wp->w_changelistidx; 3091 } 3092 ++curbuf->b_changelistlen; 3093 } 3094 } 3095 curbuf->b_changelist[curbuf->b_changelistlen - 1] = 3096 curbuf->b_last_change; 3097 /* The current window is always after the last change, so that "g," 3098 * takes you back to it. */ 3099 curwin->w_changelistidx = curbuf->b_changelistlen; 3100 #endif 3101 } 3102 3103 FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp) 3104 { 3105 if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf) 3106 { 3107 /* Mark this window to be redrawn later. */ 3108 if (wp->w_redr_type < VALID) 3109 wp->w_redr_type = VALID; 3110 3111 /* Check if a change in the buffer has invalidated the cached 3112 * values for the cursor. */ 3113 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING 3114 /* 3115 * Update the folds for this window. Can't postpone this, because 3116 * a following operator might work on the whole fold: ">>dd". 3117 */ 3118 foldUpdate(wp, lnum, lnume + xtra - 1); 3119 3120 /* The change may cause lines above or below the change to become 3121 * included in a fold. Set lnum/lnume to the first/last line that 3122 * might be displayed differently. 3123 * Set w_cline_folded here as an efficient way to update it when 3124 * inserting lines just above a closed fold. */ 3125 i = hasFoldingWin(wp, lnum, &lnum, NULL, FALSE, NULL); 3126 if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnum) 3127 wp->w_cline_folded = i; 3128 i = hasFoldingWin(wp, lnume, NULL, &lnume, FALSE, NULL); 3129 if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnume) 3130 wp->w_cline_folded = i; 3131 3132 /* If the changed line is in a range of previously folded lines, 3133 * compare with the first line in that range. */ 3134 if (wp->w_cursor.lnum <= lnum) 3135 { 3136 i = find_wl_entry(wp, lnum); 3137 if (i >= 0 && wp->w_cursor.lnum > wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum) 3138 changed_line_abv_curs_win(wp); 3139 } 3140 #endif 3141 3142 if (wp->w_cursor.lnum > lnum) 3143 changed_line_abv_curs_win(wp); 3144 else if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnum && wp->w_cursor.col >= col) 3145 changed_cline_bef_curs_win(wp); 3146 if (wp->w_botline >= lnum) 3147 { 3148 /* Assume that botline doesn't change (inserted lines make 3149 * other lines scroll down below botline). */ 3150 approximate_botline_win(wp); 3151 } 3152 3153 /* Check if any w_lines[] entries have become invalid. 3154 * For entries below the change: Correct the lnums for 3155 * inserted/deleted lines. Makes it possible to stop displaying 3156 * after the change. */ 3157 for (i = 0; i < wp->w_lines_valid; ++i) 3158 if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid) 3159 { 3160 if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum >= lnum) 3161 { 3162 if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum < lnume) 3163 { 3164 /* line included in change */ 3165 wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid = FALSE; 3166 } 3167 else if (xtra != 0) 3168 { 3169 /* line below change */ 3170 wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum += xtra; 3171 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING 3172 wp->w_lines[i].wl_lastlnum += xtra; 3173 #endif 3174 } 3175 } 3176 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING 3177 else if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lastlnum >= lnum) 3178 { 3179 /* change somewhere inside this range of folded lines, 3180 * may need to be redrawn */ 3181 wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid = FALSE; 3182 } 3183 #endif 3184 } 3185 3186 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING 3187 /* Take care of side effects for setting w_topline when folds have 3188 * changed. Esp. when the buffer was changed in another window. */ 3189 if (hasAnyFolding(wp)) 3190 set_topline(wp, wp->w_topline); 3191 #endif 3192 /* relative numbering may require updating more */ 3193 if (wp->w_p_rnu) 3194 redraw_win_later(wp, SOME_VALID); 3195 } 3196 } 3197 3198 /* Call update_screen() later, which checks out what needs to be redrawn, 3199 * since it notices b_mod_set and then uses b_mod_*. */ 3200 if (must_redraw < VALID) 3201 must_redraw = VALID; 3202 3203 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD 3204 /* when the cursor line is changed always trigger CursorMoved */ 3205 if (lnum <= curwin->w_cursor.lnum 3206 && lnume + (xtra < 0 ? -xtra : xtra) > curwin->w_cursor.lnum) 3207 last_cursormoved.lnum = 0; 3208 #endif 3209 } 3210 3211 /* 3212 * unchanged() is called when the changed flag must be reset for buffer 'buf' 3213 */ 3214 void 3215 unchanged(buf, ff) 3216 buf_T *buf; 3217 int ff; /* also reset 'fileformat' */ 3218 { 3219 if (buf->b_changed || (ff && file_ff_differs(buf, FALSE))) 3220 { 3221 buf->b_changed = 0; 3222 ml_setflags(buf); 3223 if (ff) 3224 save_file_ff(buf); 3225 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS 3226 check_status(buf); 3227 redraw_tabline = TRUE; 3228 #endif 3229 #ifdef FEAT_TITLE 3230 need_maketitle = TRUE; /* set window title later */ 3231 #endif 3232 } 3233 ++buf->b_changedtick; 3234 #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG 3235 netbeans_unmodified(buf); 3236 #endif 3237 } 3238 3239 #if defined(FEAT_WINDOWS) || defined(PROTO) 3240 /* 3241 * check_status: called when the status bars for the buffer 'buf' 3242 * need to be updated 3243 */ 3244 void 3245 check_status(buf) 3246 buf_T *buf; 3247 { 3248 win_T *wp; 3249 3250 for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next) 3251 if (wp->w_buffer == buf && wp->w_status_height) 3252 { 3253 wp->w_redr_status = TRUE; 3254 if (must_redraw < VALID) 3255 must_redraw = VALID; 3256 } 3257 } 3258 #endif 3259 3260 /* 3261 * If the file is readonly, give a warning message with the first change. 3262 * Don't do this for autocommands. 3263 * Don't use emsg(), because it flushes the macro buffer. 3264 * If we have undone all changes b_changed will be FALSE, but "b_did_warn" 3265 * will be TRUE. 3266 * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. 3267 */ 3268 void 3269 change_warning(col) 3270 int col; /* column for message; non-zero when in insert 3271 mode and 'showmode' is on */ 3272 { 3273 static char *w_readonly = N_("W10: Warning: Changing a readonly file"); 3274 3275 if (curbuf->b_did_warn == FALSE 3276 && curbufIsChanged() == 0 3277 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD 3278 && !autocmd_busy 3279 #endif 3280 && curbuf->b_p_ro) 3281 { 3282 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD 3283 ++curbuf_lock; 3284 apply_autocmds(EVENT_FILECHANGEDRO, NULL, NULL, FALSE, curbuf); 3285 --curbuf_lock; 3286 if (!curbuf->b_p_ro) 3287 return; 3288 #endif 3289 /* 3290 * Do what msg() does, but with a column offset if the warning should 3291 * be after the mode message. 3292 */ 3293 msg_start(); 3294 if (msg_row == Rows - 1) 3295 msg_col = col; 3296 msg_source(hl_attr(HLF_W)); 3297 MSG_PUTS_ATTR(_(w_readonly), hl_attr(HLF_W) | MSG_HIST); 3298 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL 3299 set_vim_var_string(VV_WARNINGMSG, (char_u *)_(w_readonly), -1); 3300 #endif 3301 msg_clr_eos(); 3302 (void)msg_end(); 3303 if (msg_silent == 0 && !silent_mode) 3304 { 3305 out_flush(); 3306 ui_delay(1000L, TRUE); /* give the user time to think about it */ 3307 } 3308 curbuf->b_did_warn = TRUE; 3309 redraw_cmdline = FALSE; /* don't redraw and erase the message */ 3310 if (msg_row < Rows - 1) 3311 showmode(); 3312 } 3313 } 3314 3315 /* 3316 * Ask for a reply from the user, a 'y' or a 'n'. 3317 * No other characters are accepted, the message is repeated until a valid 3318 * reply is entered or CTRL-C is hit. 3319 * If direct is TRUE, don't use vgetc() but ui_inchar(), don't get characters 3320 * from any buffers but directly from the user. 3321 * 3322 * return the 'y' or 'n' 3323 */ 3324 int 3325 ask_yesno(str, direct) 3326 char_u *str; 3327 int direct; 3328 { 3329 int r = ' '; 3330 int save_State = State; 3331 3332 if (exiting) /* put terminal in raw mode for this question */ 3333 settmode(TMODE_RAW); 3334 ++no_wait_return; 3335 #ifdef USE_ON_FLY_SCROLL 3336 dont_scroll = TRUE; /* disallow scrolling here */ 3337 #endif 3338 State = CONFIRM; /* mouse behaves like with :confirm */ 3339 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE 3340 setmouse(); /* disables mouse for xterm */ 3341 #endif 3342 ++no_mapping; 3343 ++allow_keys; /* no mapping here, but recognize keys */ 3344 3345 while (r != 'y' && r != 'n') 3346 { 3347 /* same highlighting as for wait_return */ 3348 smsg_attr(hl_attr(HLF_R), (char_u *)"%s (y/n)?", str); 3349 if (direct) 3350 r = get_keystroke(); 3351 else 3352 r = plain_vgetc(); 3353 if (r == Ctrl_C || r == ESC) 3354 r = 'n'; 3355 msg_putchar(r); /* show what you typed */ 3356 out_flush(); 3357 } 3358 --no_wait_return; 3359 State = save_State; 3360 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE 3361 setmouse(); 3362 #endif 3363 --no_mapping; 3364 --allow_keys; 3365 3366 return r; 3367 } 3368 3369 #if defined(FEAT_MOUSE) || defined(PROTO) 3370 /* 3371 * Return TRUE if "c" is a mouse key. 3372 */ 3373 int 3374 is_mouse_key(c) 3375 int c; 3376 { 3377 return c == K_LEFTMOUSE 3378 || c == K_LEFTMOUSE_NM 3379 || c == K_LEFTDRAG 3380 || c == K_LEFTRELEASE 3381 || c == K_LEFTRELEASE_NM 3382 || c == K_MIDDLEMOUSE 3383 || c == K_MIDDLEDRAG 3384 || c == K_MIDDLERELEASE 3385 || c == K_RIGHTMOUSE 3386 || c == K_RIGHTDRAG 3387 || c == K_RIGHTRELEASE 3388 || c == K_MOUSEDOWN 3389 || c == K_MOUSEUP 3390 || c == K_MOUSELEFT 3391 || c == K_MOUSERIGHT 3392 || c == K_X1MOUSE 3393 || c == K_X1DRAG 3394 || c == K_X1RELEASE 3395 || c == K_X2MOUSE 3396 || c == K_X2DRAG 3397 || c == K_X2RELEASE; 3398 } 3399 #endif 3400 3401 /* 3402 * Get a key stroke directly from the user. 3403 * Ignores mouse clicks and scrollbar events, except a click for the left 3404 * button (used at the more prompt). 3405 * Doesn't use vgetc(), because it syncs undo and eats mapped characters. 3406 * Disadvantage: typeahead is ignored. 3407 * Translates the interrupt character for unix to ESC. 3408 */ 3409 int 3410 get_keystroke() 3411 { 3412 char_u *buf = NULL; 3413 int buflen = 150; 3414 int maxlen; 3415 int len = 0; 3416 int n; 3417 int save_mapped_ctrl_c = mapped_ctrl_c; 3418 int waited = 0; 3419 3420 mapped_ctrl_c = FALSE; /* mappings are not used here */ 3421 for (;;) 3422 { 3423 cursor_on(); 3424 out_flush(); 3425 3426 /* Leave some room for check_termcode() to insert a key code into (max 3427 * 5 chars plus NUL). And fix_input_buffer() can triple the number of 3428 * bytes. */ 3429 maxlen = (buflen - 6 - len) / 3; 3430 if (buf == NULL) 3431 buf = alloc(buflen); 3432 else if (maxlen < 10) 3433 { 3434 char_u *t_buf = buf; 3435 3436 /* Need some more space. This might happen when receiving a long 3437 * escape sequence. */ 3438 buflen += 100; 3439 buf = vim_realloc(buf, buflen); 3440 if (buf == NULL) 3441 vim_free(t_buf); 3442 maxlen = (buflen - 6 - len) / 3; 3443 } 3444 if (buf == NULL) 3445 { 3446 do_outofmem_msg((long_u)buflen); 3447 return ESC; /* panic! */ 3448 } 3449 3450 /* First time: blocking wait. Second time: wait up to 100ms for a 3451 * terminal code to complete. */ 3452 n = ui_inchar(buf + len, maxlen, len == 0 ? -1L : 100L, 0); 3453 if (n > 0) 3454 { 3455 /* Replace zero and CSI by a special key code. */ 3456 n = fix_input_buffer(buf + len, n, FALSE); 3457 len += n; 3458 waited = 0; 3459 } 3460 else if (len > 0) 3461 ++waited; /* keep track of the waiting time */ 3462 3463 /* Incomplete termcode and not timed out yet: get more characters */ 3464 if ((n = check_termcode(1, buf, buflen, &len)) < 0 3465 && (!p_ttimeout || waited * 100L < (p_ttm < 0 ? p_tm : p_ttm))) 3466 continue; 3467 3468 if (n == KEYLEN_REMOVED) /* key code removed */ 3469 { 3470 if (must_redraw != 0 && !need_wait_return && (State & CMDLINE) == 0) 3471 { 3472 /* Redrawing was postponed, do it now. */ 3473 update_screen(0); 3474 setcursor(); /* put cursor back where it belongs */ 3475 } 3476 continue; 3477 } 3478 if (n > 0) /* found a termcode: adjust length */ 3479 len = n; 3480 if (len == 0) /* nothing typed yet */ 3481 continue; 3482 3483 /* Handle modifier and/or special key code. */ 3484 n = buf[0]; 3485 if (n == K_SPECIAL) 3486 { 3487 n = TO_SPECIAL(buf[1], buf[2]); 3488 if (buf[1] == KS_MODIFIER 3489 || n == K_IGNORE 3490 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE 3491 || (is_mouse_key(n) && n != K_LEFTMOUSE) 3492 #endif 3493 #ifdef FEAT_GUI 3494 || n == K_VER_SCROLLBAR 3495 || n == K_HOR_SCROLLBAR 3496 #endif 3497 ) 3498 { 3499 if (buf[1] == KS_MODIFIER) 3500 mod_mask = buf[2]; 3501 len -= 3; 3502 if (len > 0) 3503 mch_memmove(buf, buf + 3, (size_t)len); 3504 continue; 3505 } 3506 break; 3507 } 3508 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 3509 if (has_mbyte) 3510 { 3511 if (MB_BYTE2LEN(n) > len) 3512 continue; /* more bytes to get */ 3513 buf[len >= buflen ? buflen - 1 : len] = NUL; 3514 n = (*mb_ptr2char)(buf); 3515 } 3516 #endif 3517 #ifdef UNIX 3518 if (n == intr_char) 3519 n = ESC; 3520 #endif 3521 break; 3522 } 3523 vim_free(buf); 3524 3525 mapped_ctrl_c = save_mapped_ctrl_c; 3526 return n; 3527 } 3528 3529 /* 3530 * Get a number from the user. 3531 * When "mouse_used" is not NULL allow using the mouse. 3532 */ 3533 int 3534 get_number(colon, mouse_used) 3535 int colon; /* allow colon to abort */ 3536 int *mouse_used; 3537 { 3538 int n = 0; 3539 int c; 3540 int typed = 0; 3541 3542 if (mouse_used != NULL) 3543 *mouse_used = FALSE; 3544 3545 /* When not printing messages, the user won't know what to type, return a 3546 * zero (as if CR was hit). */ 3547 if (msg_silent != 0) 3548 return 0; 3549 3550 #ifdef USE_ON_FLY_SCROLL 3551 dont_scroll = TRUE; /* disallow scrolling here */ 3552 #endif 3553 ++no_mapping; 3554 ++allow_keys; /* no mapping here, but recognize keys */ 3555 for (;;) 3556 { 3557 windgoto(msg_row, msg_col); 3558 c = safe_vgetc(); 3559 if (VIM_ISDIGIT(c)) 3560 { 3561 n = n * 10 + c - '0'; 3562 msg_putchar(c); 3563 ++typed; 3564 } 3565 else if (c == K_DEL || c == K_KDEL || c == K_BS || c == Ctrl_H) 3566 { 3567 if (typed > 0) 3568 { 3569 MSG_PUTS("\b \b"); 3570 --typed; 3571 } 3572 n /= 10; 3573 } 3574 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE 3575 else if (mouse_used != NULL && c == K_LEFTMOUSE) 3576 { 3577 *mouse_used = TRUE; 3578 n = mouse_row + 1; 3579 break; 3580 } 3581 #endif 3582 else if (n == 0 && c == ':' && colon) 3583 { 3584 stuffcharReadbuff(':'); 3585 if (!exmode_active) 3586 cmdline_row = msg_row; 3587 skip_redraw = TRUE; /* skip redraw once */ 3588 do_redraw = FALSE; 3589 break; 3590 } 3591 else if (c == CAR || c == NL || c == Ctrl_C || c == ESC) 3592 break; 3593 } 3594 --no_mapping; 3595 --allow_keys; 3596 return n; 3597 } 3598 3599 /* 3600 * Ask the user to enter a number. 3601 * When "mouse_used" is not NULL allow using the mouse and in that case return 3602 * the line number. 3603 */ 3604 int 3605 prompt_for_number(mouse_used) 3606 int *mouse_used; 3607 { 3608 int i; 3609 int save_cmdline_row; 3610 int save_State; 3611 3612 /* When using ":silent" assume that <CR> was entered. */ 3613 if (mouse_used != NULL) 3614 MSG_PUTS(_("Type number and <Enter> or click with mouse (empty cancels): ")); 3615 else 3616 MSG_PUTS(_("Type number and <Enter> (empty cancels): ")); 3617 3618 /* Set the state such that text can be selected/copied/pasted and we still 3619 * get mouse events. */ 3620 save_cmdline_row = cmdline_row; 3621 cmdline_row = 0; 3622 save_State = State; 3623 State = CMDLINE; 3624 3625 i = get_number(TRUE, mouse_used); 3626 if (KeyTyped) 3627 { 3628 /* don't call wait_return() now */ 3629 /* msg_putchar('\n'); */ 3630 cmdline_row = msg_row - 1; 3631 need_wait_return = FALSE; 3632 msg_didany = FALSE; 3633 msg_didout = FALSE; 3634 } 3635 else 3636 cmdline_row = save_cmdline_row; 3637 State = save_State; 3638 3639 return i; 3640 } 3641 3642 void 3643 msgmore(n) 3644 long n; 3645 { 3646 long pn; 3647 3648 if (global_busy /* no messages now, wait until global is finished */ 3649 || !messaging()) /* 'lazyredraw' set, don't do messages now */ 3650 return; 3651 3652 /* We don't want to overwrite another important message, but do overwrite 3653 * a previous "more lines" or "fewer lines" message, so that "5dd" and 3654 * then "put" reports the last action. */ 3655 if (keep_msg != NULL && !keep_msg_more) 3656 return; 3657 3658 if (n > 0) 3659 pn = n; 3660 else 3661 pn = -n; 3662 3663 if (pn > p_report) 3664 { 3665 if (pn == 1) 3666 { 3667 if (n > 0) 3668 vim_strncpy(msg_buf, (char_u *)_("1 more line"), 3669 MSG_BUF_LEN - 1); 3670 else 3671 vim_strncpy(msg_buf, (char_u *)_("1 line less"), 3672 MSG_BUF_LEN - 1); 3673 } 3674 else 3675 { 3676 if (n > 0) 3677 vim_snprintf((char *)msg_buf, MSG_BUF_LEN, 3678 _("%ld more lines"), pn); 3679 else 3680 vim_snprintf((char *)msg_buf, MSG_BUF_LEN, 3681 _("%ld fewer lines"), pn); 3682 } 3683 if (got_int) 3684 vim_strcat(msg_buf, (char_u *)_(" (Interrupted)"), MSG_BUF_LEN); 3685 if (msg(msg_buf)) 3686 { 3687 set_keep_msg(msg_buf, 0); 3688 keep_msg_more = TRUE; 3689 } 3690 } 3691 } 3692 3693 /* 3694 * flush map and typeahead buffers and give a warning for an error 3695 */ 3696 void 3697 beep_flush() 3698 { 3699 if (emsg_silent == 0) 3700 { 3701 flush_buffers(FALSE); 3702 vim_beep(BO_ERROR); 3703 } 3704 } 3705 3706 /* 3707 * Give a warning for an error. 3708 */ 3709 void 3710 vim_beep(val) 3711 unsigned val; /* one of the BO_ values, e.g., BO_OPER */ 3712 { 3713 if (emsg_silent == 0) 3714 { 3715 if (!((bo_flags & val) || (bo_flags & BO_ALL))) 3716 { 3717 if (p_vb 3718 #ifdef FEAT_GUI 3719 /* While the GUI is starting up the termcap is set for the 3720 * GUI but the output still goes to a terminal. */ 3721 && !(gui.in_use && gui.starting) 3722 #endif 3723 ) 3724 { 3725 out_str(T_VB); 3726 } 3727 else 3728 { 3729 #ifdef MSDOS 3730 /* 3731 * The number of beeps outputted is reduced to avoid having to 3732 * wait for all the beeps to finish. This is only a problem on 3733 * systems where the beeps don't overlap. 3734 */ 3735 if (beep_count == 0 || beep_count == 10) 3736 { 3737 out_char(BELL); 3738 beep_count = 1; 3739 } 3740 else 3741 ++beep_count; 3742 #else 3743 out_char(BELL); 3744 #endif 3745 } 3746 } 3747 3748 /* When 'verbose' is set and we are sourcing a script or executing a 3749 * function give the user a hint where the beep comes from. */ 3750 if (vim_strchr(p_debug, 'e') != NULL) 3751 { 3752 msg_source(hl_attr(HLF_W)); 3753 msg_attr((char_u *)_("Beep!"), hl_attr(HLF_W)); 3754 } 3755 } 3756 } 3757 3758 /* 3759 * To get the "real" home directory: 3760 * - get value of $HOME 3761 * For Unix: 3762 * - go to that directory 3763 * - do mch_dirname() to get the real name of that directory. 3764 * This also works with mounts and links. 3765 * Don't do this for MS-DOS, it will change the "current dir" for a drive. 3766 */ 3767 static char_u *homedir = NULL; 3768 3769 void 3770 init_homedir() 3771 { 3772 char_u *var; 3773 3774 /* In case we are called a second time (when 'encoding' changes). */ 3775 vim_free(homedir); 3776 homedir = NULL; 3777 3778 #ifdef VMS 3779 var = mch_getenv((char_u *)"SYS$LOGIN"); 3780 #else 3781 var = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOME"); 3782 #endif 3783 3784 if (var != NULL && *var == NUL) /* empty is same as not set */ 3785 var = NULL; 3786 3787 #ifdef WIN3264 3788 /* 3789 * Weird but true: $HOME may contain an indirect reference to another 3790 * variable, esp. "%USERPROFILE%". Happens when $USERPROFILE isn't set 3791 * when $HOME is being set. 3792 */ 3793 if (var != NULL && *var == '%') 3794 { 3795 char_u *p; 3796 char_u *exp; 3797 3798 p = vim_strchr(var + 1, '%'); 3799 if (p != NULL) 3800 { 3801 vim_strncpy(NameBuff, var + 1, p - (var + 1)); 3802 exp = mch_getenv(NameBuff); 3803 if (exp != NULL && *exp != NUL 3804 && STRLEN(exp) + STRLEN(p) < MAXPATHL) 3805 { 3806 vim_snprintf((char *)NameBuff, MAXPATHL, "%s%s", exp, p + 1); 3807 var = NameBuff; 3808 /* Also set $HOME, it's needed for _viminfo. */ 3809 vim_setenv((char_u *)"HOME", NameBuff); 3810 } 3811 } 3812 } 3813 3814 /* 3815 * Typically, $HOME is not defined on Windows, unless the user has 3816 * specifically defined it for Vim's sake. However, on Windows NT 3817 * platforms, $HOMEDRIVE and $HOMEPATH are automatically defined for 3818 * each user. Try constructing $HOME from these. 3819 */ 3820 if (var == NULL) 3821 { 3822 char_u *homedrive, *homepath; 3823 3824 homedrive = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOMEDRIVE"); 3825 homepath = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOMEPATH"); 3826 if (homepath == NULL || *homepath == NUL) 3827 homepath = "\\"; 3828 if (homedrive != NULL 3829 && STRLEN(homedrive) + STRLEN(homepath) < MAXPATHL) 3830 { 3831 sprintf((char *)NameBuff, "%s%s", homedrive, homepath); 3832 if (NameBuff[0] != NUL) 3833 { 3834 var = NameBuff; 3835 /* Also set $HOME, it's needed for _viminfo. */ 3836 vim_setenv((char_u *)"HOME", NameBuff); 3837 } 3838 } 3839 } 3840 3841 # if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) 3842 if (enc_utf8 && var != NULL) 3843 { 3844 int len; 3845 char_u *pp = NULL; 3846 3847 /* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8. Other conversions are 3848 * not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII characters. */ 3849 acp_to_enc(var, (int)STRLEN(var), &pp, &len); 3850 if (pp != NULL) 3851 { 3852 homedir = pp; 3853 return; 3854 } 3855 } 3856 # endif 3857 #endif 3858 3859 #if defined(OS2) || defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) 3860 /* 3861 * Default home dir is C:/ 3862 * Best assumption we can make in such a situation. 3863 */ 3864 if (var == NULL) 3865 var = "C:/"; 3866 #endif 3867 if (var != NULL) 3868 { 3869 #ifdef UNIX 3870 /* 3871 * Change to the directory and get the actual path. This resolves 3872 * links. Don't do it when we can't return. 3873 */ 3874 if (mch_dirname(NameBuff, MAXPATHL) == OK 3875 && mch_chdir((char *)NameBuff) == 0) 3876 { 3877 if (!mch_chdir((char *)var) && mch_dirname(IObuff, IOSIZE) == OK) 3878 var = IObuff; 3879 if (mch_chdir((char *)NameBuff) != 0) 3880 EMSG(_(e_prev_dir)); 3881 } 3882 #endif 3883 homedir = vim_strsave(var); 3884 } 3885 } 3886 3887 #if defined(EXITFREE) || defined(PROTO) 3888 void 3889 free_homedir() 3890 { 3891 vim_free(homedir); 3892 } 3893 3894 # ifdef FEAT_CMDL_COMPL 3895 void 3896 free_users() 3897 { 3898 ga_clear_strings(&ga_users); 3899 } 3900 # endif 3901 #endif 3902 3903 /* 3904 * Call expand_env() and store the result in an allocated string. 3905 * This is not very memory efficient, this expects the result to be freed 3906 * again soon. 3907 */ 3908 char_u * 3909 expand_env_save(src) 3910 char_u *src; 3911 { 3912 return expand_env_save_opt(src, FALSE); 3913 } 3914 3915 /* 3916 * Idem, but when "one" is TRUE handle the string as one file name, only 3917 * expand "~" at the start. 3918 */ 3919 char_u * 3920 expand_env_save_opt(src, one) 3921 char_u *src; 3922 int one; 3923 { 3924 char_u *p; 3925 3926 p = alloc(MAXPATHL); 3927 if (p != NULL) 3928 expand_env_esc(src, p, MAXPATHL, FALSE, one, NULL); 3929 return p; 3930 } 3931 3932 /* 3933 * Expand environment variable with path name. 3934 * "~/" is also expanded, using $HOME. For Unix "~user/" is expanded. 3935 * Skips over "\ ", "\~" and "\$" (not for Win32 though). 3936 * If anything fails no expansion is done and dst equals src. 3937 */ 3938 void 3939 expand_env(src, dst, dstlen) 3940 char_u *src; /* input string e.g. "$HOME/vim.hlp" */ 3941 char_u *dst; /* where to put the result */ 3942 int dstlen; /* maximum length of the result */ 3943 { 3944 expand_env_esc(src, dst, dstlen, FALSE, FALSE, NULL); 3945 } 3946 3947 void 3948 expand_env_esc(srcp, dst, dstlen, esc, one, startstr) 3949 char_u *srcp; /* input string e.g. "$HOME/vim.hlp" */ 3950 char_u *dst; /* where to put the result */ 3951 int dstlen; /* maximum length of the result */ 3952 int esc; /* escape spaces in expanded variables */ 3953 int one; /* "srcp" is one file name */ 3954 char_u *startstr; /* start again after this (can be NULL) */ 3955 { 3956 char_u *src; 3957 char_u *tail; 3958 int c; 3959 char_u *var; 3960 int copy_char; 3961 int mustfree; /* var was allocated, need to free it later */ 3962 int at_start = TRUE; /* at start of a name */ 3963 int startstr_len = 0; 3964 3965 if (startstr != NULL) 3966 startstr_len = (int)STRLEN(startstr); 3967 3968 src = skipwhite(srcp); 3969 --dstlen; /* leave one char space for "\," */ 3970 while (*src && dstlen > 0) 3971 { 3972 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL 3973 /* Skip over `=expr`. */ 3974 if (src[0] == '`' && src[1] == '=') 3975 { 3976 size_t len; 3977 3978 var = src; 3979 src += 2; 3980 (void)skip_expr(&src); 3981 if (*src == '`') 3982 ++src; 3983 len = src - var; 3984 if (len > (size_t)dstlen) 3985 len = dstlen; 3986 vim_strncpy(dst, var, len); 3987 dst += len; 3988 dstlen -= (int)len; 3989 continue; 3990 } 3991 #endif 3992 copy_char = TRUE; 3993 if ((*src == '$' 3994 #ifdef VMS 3995 && at_start 3996 #endif 3997 ) 3998 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) 3999 || *src == '%' 4000 #endif 4001 || (*src == '~' && at_start)) 4002 { 4003 mustfree = FALSE; 4004 4005 /* 4006 * The variable name is copied into dst temporarily, because it may 4007 * be a string in read-only memory and a NUL needs to be appended. 4008 */ 4009 if (*src != '~') /* environment var */ 4010 { 4011 tail = src + 1; 4012 var = dst; 4013 c = dstlen - 1; 4014 4015 #ifdef UNIX 4016 /* Unix has ${var-name} type environment vars */ 4017 if (*tail == '{' && !vim_isIDc('{')) 4018 { 4019 tail++; /* ignore '{' */ 4020 while (c-- > 0 && *tail && *tail != '}') 4021 *var++ = *tail++; 4022 } 4023 else 4024 #endif 4025 { 4026 while (c-- > 0 && *tail != NUL && ((vim_isIDc(*tail)) 4027 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) 4028 || (*src == '%' && *tail != '%') 4029 #endif 4030 )) 4031 { 4032 #ifdef OS2 /* env vars only in uppercase */ 4033 *var++ = TOUPPER_LOC(*tail); 4034 tail++; /* toupper() may be a macro! */ 4035 #else 4036 *var++ = *tail++; 4037 #endif 4038 } 4039 } 4040 4041 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) || defined(UNIX) 4042 # ifdef UNIX 4043 if (src[1] == '{' && *tail != '}') 4044 # else 4045 if (*src == '%' && *tail != '%') 4046 # endif 4047 var = NULL; 4048 else 4049 { 4050 # ifdef UNIX 4051 if (src[1] == '{') 4052 # else 4053 if (*src == '%') 4054 #endif 4055 ++tail; 4056 #endif 4057 *var = NUL; 4058 var = vim_getenv(dst, &mustfree); 4059 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) || defined(UNIX) 4060 } 4061 #endif 4062 } 4063 /* home directory */ 4064 else if ( src[1] == NUL 4065 || vim_ispathsep(src[1]) 4066 || vim_strchr((char_u *)" ,\t\n", src[1]) != NULL) 4067 { 4068 var = homedir; 4069 tail = src + 1; 4070 } 4071 else /* user directory */ 4072 { 4073 #if defined(UNIX) || (defined(VMS) && defined(USER_HOME)) 4074 /* 4075 * Copy ~user to dst[], so we can put a NUL after it. 4076 */ 4077 tail = src; 4078 var = dst; 4079 c = dstlen - 1; 4080 while ( c-- > 0 4081 && *tail 4082 && vim_isfilec(*tail) 4083 && !vim_ispathsep(*tail)) 4084 *var++ = *tail++; 4085 *var = NUL; 4086 # ifdef UNIX 4087 /* 4088 * If the system supports getpwnam(), use it. 4089 * Otherwise, or if getpwnam() fails, the shell is used to 4090 * expand ~user. This is slower and may fail if the shell 4091 * does not support ~user (old versions of /bin/sh). 4092 */ 4093 # if defined(HAVE_GETPWNAM) && defined(HAVE_PWD_H) 4094 { 4095 struct passwd *pw; 4096 4097 /* Note: memory allocated by getpwnam() is never freed. 4098 * Calling endpwent() apparently doesn't help. */ 4099 pw = getpwnam((char *)dst + 1); 4100 if (pw != NULL) 4101 var = (char_u *)pw->pw_dir; 4102 else 4103 var = NULL; 4104 } 4105 if (var == NULL) 4106 # endif 4107 { 4108 expand_T xpc; 4109 4110 ExpandInit(&xpc); 4111 xpc.xp_context = EXPAND_FILES; 4112 var = ExpandOne(&xpc, dst, NULL, 4113 WILD_ADD_SLASH|WILD_SILENT, WILD_EXPAND_FREE); 4114 mustfree = TRUE; 4115 } 4116 4117 # else /* !UNIX, thus VMS */ 4118 /* 4119 * USER_HOME is a comma-separated list of 4120 * directories to search for the user account in. 4121 */ 4122 { 4123 char_u test[MAXPATHL], paths[MAXPATHL]; 4124 char_u *path, *next_path, *ptr; 4125 struct stat st; 4126 4127 STRCPY(paths, USER_HOME); 4128 next_path = paths; 4129 while (*next_path) 4130 { 4131 for (path = next_path; *next_path && *next_path != ','; 4132 next_path++); 4133 if (*next_path) 4134 *next_path++ = NUL; 4135 STRCPY(test, path); 4136 STRCAT(test, "/"); 4137 STRCAT(test, dst + 1); 4138 if (mch_stat(test, &st) == 0) 4139 { 4140 var = alloc(STRLEN(test) + 1); 4141 STRCPY(var, test); 4142 mustfree = TRUE; 4143 break; 4144 } 4145 } 4146 } 4147 # endif /* UNIX */ 4148 #else 4149 /* cannot expand user's home directory, so don't try */ 4150 var = NULL; 4151 tail = (char_u *)""; /* for gcc */ 4152 #endif /* UNIX || VMS */ 4153 } 4154 4155 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME 4156 /* If 'shellslash' is set change backslashes to forward slashes. 4157 * Can't use slash_adjust(), p_ssl may be set temporarily. */ 4158 if (p_ssl && var != NULL && vim_strchr(var, '\\') != NULL) 4159 { 4160 char_u *p = vim_strsave(var); 4161 4162 if (p != NULL) 4163 { 4164 if (mustfree) 4165 vim_free(var); 4166 var = p; 4167 mustfree = TRUE; 4168 forward_slash(var); 4169 } 4170 } 4171 #endif 4172 4173 /* If "var" contains white space, escape it with a backslash. 4174 * Required for ":e ~/tt" when $HOME includes a space. */ 4175 if (esc && var != NULL && vim_strpbrk(var, (char_u *)" \t") != NULL) 4176 { 4177 char_u *p = vim_strsave_escaped(var, (char_u *)" \t"); 4178 4179 if (p != NULL) 4180 { 4181 if (mustfree) 4182 vim_free(var); 4183 var = p; 4184 mustfree = TRUE; 4185 } 4186 } 4187 4188 if (var != NULL && *var != NUL 4189 && (STRLEN(var) + STRLEN(tail) + 1 < (unsigned)dstlen)) 4190 { 4191 STRCPY(dst, var); 4192 dstlen -= (int)STRLEN(var); 4193 c = (int)STRLEN(var); 4194 /* if var[] ends in a path separator and tail[] starts 4195 * with it, skip a character */ 4196 if (*var != NUL && after_pathsep(dst, dst + c) 4197 #if defined(BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME) || defined(AMIGA) 4198 && dst[-1] != ':' 4199 #endif 4200 && vim_ispathsep(*tail)) 4201 ++tail; 4202 dst += c; 4203 src = tail; 4204 copy_char = FALSE; 4205 } 4206 if (mustfree) 4207 vim_free(var); 4208 } 4209 4210 if (copy_char) /* copy at least one char */ 4211 { 4212 /* 4213 * Recognize the start of a new name, for '~'. 4214 * Don't do this when "one" is TRUE, to avoid expanding "~" in 4215 * ":edit foo ~ foo". 4216 */ 4217 at_start = FALSE; 4218 if (src[0] == '\\' && src[1] != NUL) 4219 { 4220 *dst++ = *src++; 4221 --dstlen; 4222 } 4223 else if ((src[0] == ' ' || src[0] == ',') && !one) 4224 at_start = TRUE; 4225 *dst++ = *src++; 4226 --dstlen; 4227 4228 if (startstr != NULL && src - startstr_len >= srcp 4229 && STRNCMP(src - startstr_len, startstr, startstr_len) == 0) 4230 at_start = TRUE; 4231 } 4232 } 4233 *dst = NUL; 4234 } 4235 4236 /* 4237 * Vim's version of getenv(). 4238 * Special handling of $HOME, $VIM and $VIMRUNTIME. 4239 * Also does ACP to 'enc' conversion for Win32. 4240 * "mustfree" is set to TRUE when returned is allocated, it must be 4241 * initialized to FALSE by the caller. 4242 */ 4243 char_u * 4244 vim_getenv(name, mustfree) 4245 char_u *name; 4246 int *mustfree; 4247 { 4248 char_u *p; 4249 char_u *pend; 4250 int vimruntime; 4251 4252 #if defined(OS2) || defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) 4253 /* use "C:/" when $HOME is not set */ 4254 if (STRCMP(name, "HOME") == 0) 4255 return homedir; 4256 #endif 4257 4258 p = mch_getenv(name); 4259 if (p != NULL && *p == NUL) /* empty is the same as not set */ 4260 p = NULL; 4261 4262 if (p != NULL) 4263 { 4264 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) && defined(WIN3264) 4265 if (enc_utf8) 4266 { 4267 int len; 4268 char_u *pp = NULL; 4269 4270 /* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8. Other conversions are 4271 * not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII characters. */ 4272 acp_to_enc(p, (int)STRLEN(p), &pp, &len); 4273 if (pp != NULL) 4274 { 4275 p = pp; 4276 *mustfree = TRUE; 4277 } 4278 } 4279 #endif 4280 return p; 4281 } 4282 4283 vimruntime = (STRCMP(name, "VIMRUNTIME") == 0); 4284 if (!vimruntime && STRCMP(name, "VIM") != 0) 4285 return NULL; 4286 4287 /* 4288 * When expanding $VIMRUNTIME fails, try using $VIM/vim<version> or $VIM. 4289 * Don't do this when default_vimruntime_dir is non-empty. 4290 */ 4291 if (vimruntime 4292 #ifdef HAVE_PATHDEF 4293 && *default_vimruntime_dir == NUL 4294 #endif 4295 ) 4296 { 4297 p = mch_getenv((char_u *)"VIM"); 4298 if (p != NULL && *p == NUL) /* empty is the same as not set */ 4299 p = NULL; 4300 if (p != NULL) 4301 { 4302 p = vim_version_dir(p); 4303 if (p != NULL) 4304 *mustfree = TRUE; 4305 else 4306 p = mch_getenv((char_u *)"VIM"); 4307 4308 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) && defined(WIN3264) 4309 if (enc_utf8) 4310 { 4311 int len; 4312 char_u *pp = NULL; 4313 4314 /* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8. Other conversions 4315 * are not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII 4316 * characters. */ 4317 acp_to_enc(p, (int)STRLEN(p), &pp, &len); 4318 if (pp != NULL) 4319 { 4320 if (*mustfree) 4321 vim_free(p); 4322 p = pp; 4323 *mustfree = TRUE; 4324 } 4325 } 4326 #endif 4327 } 4328 } 4329 4330 /* 4331 * When expanding $VIM or $VIMRUNTIME fails, try using: 4332 * - the directory name from 'helpfile' (unless it contains '$') 4333 * - the executable name from argv[0] 4334 */ 4335 if (p == NULL) 4336 { 4337 if (p_hf != NULL && vim_strchr(p_hf, '$') == NULL) 4338 p = p_hf; 4339 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME 4340 /* 4341 * Use the name of the executable, obtained from argv[0]. 4342 */ 4343 else 4344 p = exe_name; 4345 #endif 4346 if (p != NULL) 4347 { 4348 /* remove the file name */ 4349 pend = gettail(p); 4350 4351 /* remove "doc/" from 'helpfile', if present */ 4352 if (p == p_hf) 4353 pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"doc"); 4354 4355 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME 4356 # ifdef MACOS_X 4357 /* remove "MacOS" from exe_name and add "Resources/vim" */ 4358 if (p == exe_name) 4359 { 4360 char_u *pend1; 4361 char_u *pnew; 4362 4363 pend1 = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"MacOS"); 4364 if (pend1 != pend) 4365 { 4366 pnew = alloc((unsigned)(pend1 - p) + 15); 4367 if (pnew != NULL) 4368 { 4369 STRNCPY(pnew, p, (pend1 - p)); 4370 STRCPY(pnew + (pend1 - p), "Resources/vim"); 4371 p = pnew; 4372 pend = p + STRLEN(p); 4373 } 4374 } 4375 } 4376 # endif 4377 /* remove "src/" from exe_name, if present */ 4378 if (p == exe_name) 4379 pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"src"); 4380 #endif 4381 4382 /* for $VIM, remove "runtime/" or "vim54/", if present */ 4383 if (!vimruntime) 4384 { 4385 pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)RUNTIME_DIRNAME); 4386 pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)VIM_VERSION_NODOT); 4387 } 4388 4389 /* remove trailing path separator */ 4390 #ifndef MACOS_CLASSIC 4391 /* With MacOS path (with colons) the final colon is required */ 4392 /* to avoid confusion between absolute and relative path */ 4393 if (pend > p && after_pathsep(p, pend)) 4394 --pend; 4395 #endif 4396 4397 #ifdef MACOS_X 4398 if (p == exe_name || p == p_hf) 4399 #endif 4400 /* check that the result is a directory name */ 4401 p = vim_strnsave(p, (int)(pend - p)); 4402 4403 if (p != NULL && !mch_isdir(p)) 4404 { 4405 vim_free(p); 4406 p = NULL; 4407 } 4408 else 4409 { 4410 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME 4411 /* may add "/vim54" or "/runtime" if it exists */ 4412 if (vimruntime && (pend = vim_version_dir(p)) != NULL) 4413 { 4414 vim_free(p); 4415 p = pend; 4416 } 4417 #endif 4418 *mustfree = TRUE; 4419 } 4420 } 4421 } 4422 4423 #ifdef HAVE_PATHDEF 4424 /* When there is a pathdef.c file we can use default_vim_dir and 4425 * default_vimruntime_dir */ 4426 if (p == NULL) 4427 { 4428 /* Only use default_vimruntime_dir when it is not empty */ 4429 if (vimruntime && *default_vimruntime_dir != NUL) 4430 { 4431 p = default_vimruntime_dir; 4432 *mustfree = FALSE; 4433 } 4434 else if (*default_vim_dir != NUL) 4435 { 4436 if (vimruntime && (p = vim_version_dir(default_vim_dir)) != NULL) 4437 *mustfree = TRUE; 4438 else 4439 { 4440 p = default_vim_dir; 4441 *mustfree = FALSE; 4442 } 4443 } 4444 } 4445 #endif 4446 4447 /* 4448 * Set the environment variable, so that the new value can be found fast 4449 * next time, and others can also use it (e.g. Perl). 4450 */ 4451 if (p != NULL) 4452 { 4453 if (vimruntime) 4454 { 4455 vim_setenv((char_u *)"VIMRUNTIME", p); 4456 didset_vimruntime = TRUE; 4457 } 4458 else 4459 { 4460 vim_setenv((char_u *)"VIM", p); 4461 didset_vim = TRUE; 4462 } 4463 } 4464 return p; 4465 } 4466 4467 /* 4468 * Check if the directory "vimdir/<version>" or "vimdir/runtime" exists. 4469 * Return NULL if not, return its name in allocated memory otherwise. 4470 */ 4471 static char_u * 4472 vim_version_dir(vimdir) 4473 char_u *vimdir; 4474 { 4475 char_u *p; 4476 4477 if (vimdir == NULL || *vimdir == NUL) 4478 return NULL; 4479 p = concat_fnames(vimdir, (char_u *)VIM_VERSION_NODOT, TRUE); 4480 if (p != NULL && mch_isdir(p)) 4481 return p; 4482 vim_free(p); 4483 p = concat_fnames(vimdir, (char_u *)RUNTIME_DIRNAME, TRUE); 4484 if (p != NULL && mch_isdir(p)) 4485 return p; 4486 vim_free(p); 4487 return NULL; 4488 } 4489 4490 /* 4491 * If the string between "p" and "pend" ends in "name/", return "pend" minus 4492 * the length of "name/". Otherwise return "pend". 4493 */ 4494 static char_u * 4495 remove_tail(p, pend, name) 4496 char_u *p; 4497 char_u *pend; 4498 char_u *name; 4499 { 4500 int len = (int)STRLEN(name) + 1; 4501 char_u *newend = pend - len; 4502 4503 if (newend >= p 4504 && fnamencmp(newend, name, len - 1) == 0 4505 && (newend == p || after_pathsep(p, newend))) 4506 return newend; 4507 return pend; 4508 } 4509 4510 /* 4511 * Our portable version of setenv. 4512 */ 4513 void 4514 vim_setenv(name, val) 4515 char_u *name; 4516 char_u *val; 4517 { 4518 #ifdef HAVE_SETENV 4519 mch_setenv((char *)name, (char *)val, 1); 4520 #else 4521 char_u *envbuf; 4522 4523 /* 4524 * Putenv does not copy the string, it has to remain 4525 * valid. The allocated memory will never be freed. 4526 */ 4527 envbuf = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(name) + STRLEN(val) + 2)); 4528 if (envbuf != NULL) 4529 { 4530 sprintf((char *)envbuf, "%s=%s", name, val); 4531 putenv((char *)envbuf); 4532 } 4533 #endif 4534 #ifdef FEAT_GETTEXT 4535 /* 4536 * When setting $VIMRUNTIME adjust the directory to find message 4537 * translations to $VIMRUNTIME/lang. 4538 */ 4539 if (*val != NUL && STRICMP(name, "VIMRUNTIME") == 0) 4540 { 4541 char_u *buf = concat_str(val, (char_u *)"/lang"); 4542 4543 if (buf != NULL) 4544 { 4545 bindtextdomain(VIMPACKAGE, (char *)buf); 4546 vim_free(buf); 4547 } 4548 } 4549 #endif 4550 } 4551 4552 #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO) 4553 /* 4554 * Function given to ExpandGeneric() to obtain an environment variable name. 4555 */ 4556 char_u * 4557 get_env_name(xp, idx) 4558 expand_T *xp UNUSED; 4559 int idx; 4560 { 4561 # if defined(AMIGA) || defined(__MRC__) || defined(__SC__) 4562 /* 4563 * No environ[] on the Amiga and on the Mac (using MPW). 4564 */ 4565 return NULL; 4566 # else 4567 # ifndef __WIN32__ 4568 /* Borland C++ 5.2 has this in a header file. */ 4569 extern char **environ; 4570 # endif 4571 # define ENVNAMELEN 100 4572 static char_u name[ENVNAMELEN]; 4573 char_u *str; 4574 int n; 4575 4576 str = (char_u *)environ[idx]; 4577 if (str == NULL) 4578 return NULL; 4579 4580 for (n = 0; n < ENVNAMELEN - 1; ++n) 4581 { 4582 if (str[n] == '=' || str[n] == NUL) 4583 break; 4584 name[n] = str[n]; 4585 } 4586 name[n] = NUL; 4587 return name; 4588 # endif 4589 } 4590 4591 /* 4592 * Find all user names for user completion. 4593 * Done only once and then cached. 4594 */ 4595 static void 4596 init_users() 4597 { 4598 static int lazy_init_done = FALSE; 4599 4600 if (lazy_init_done) 4601 return; 4602 4603 lazy_init_done = TRUE; 4604 ga_init2(&ga_users, sizeof(char_u *), 20); 4605 4606 # if defined(HAVE_GETPWENT) && defined(HAVE_PWD_H) 4607 { 4608 char_u* user; 4609 struct passwd* pw; 4610 4611 setpwent(); 4612 while ((pw = getpwent()) != NULL) 4613 /* pw->pw_name shouldn't be NULL but just in case... */ 4614 if (pw->pw_name != NULL) 4615 { 4616 if (ga_grow(&ga_users, 1) == FAIL) 4617 break; 4618 user = vim_strsave((char_u*)pw->pw_name); 4619 if (user == NULL) 4620 break; 4621 ((char_u **)(ga_users.ga_data))[ga_users.ga_len++] = user; 4622 } 4623 endpwent(); 4624 } 4625 # endif 4626 } 4627 4628 /* 4629 * Function given to ExpandGeneric() to obtain an user names. 4630 */ 4631 char_u* 4632 get_users(xp, idx) 4633 expand_T *xp UNUSED; 4634 int idx; 4635 { 4636 init_users(); 4637 if (idx < ga_users.ga_len) 4638 return ((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[idx]; 4639 return NULL; 4640 } 4641 4642 /* 4643 * Check whether name matches a user name. Return: 4644 * 0 if name does not match any user name. 4645 * 1 if name partially matches the beginning of a user name. 4646 * 2 is name fully matches a user name. 4647 */ 4648 int match_user(name) 4649 char_u* name; 4650 { 4651 int i; 4652 int n = (int)STRLEN(name); 4653 int result = 0; 4654 4655 init_users(); 4656 for (i = 0; i < ga_users.ga_len; i++) 4657 { 4658 if (STRCMP(((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[i], name) == 0) 4659 return 2; /* full match */ 4660 if (STRNCMP(((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[i], name, n) == 0) 4661 result = 1; /* partial match */ 4662 } 4663 return result; 4664 } 4665 #endif 4666 4667 /* 4668 * Replace home directory by "~" in each space or comma separated file name in 4669 * 'src'. 4670 * If anything fails (except when out of space) dst equals src. 4671 */ 4672 void 4673 home_replace(buf, src, dst, dstlen, one) 4674 buf_T *buf; /* when not NULL, check for help files */ 4675 char_u *src; /* input file name */ 4676 char_u *dst; /* where to put the result */ 4677 int dstlen; /* maximum length of the result */ 4678 int one; /* if TRUE, only replace one file name, include 4679 spaces and commas in the file name. */ 4680 { 4681 size_t dirlen = 0, envlen = 0; 4682 size_t len; 4683 char_u *homedir_env, *homedir_env_orig; 4684 char_u *p; 4685 4686 if (src == NULL) 4687 { 4688 *dst = NUL; 4689 return; 4690 } 4691 4692 /* 4693 * If the file is a help file, remove the path completely. 4694 */ 4695 if (buf != NULL && buf->b_help) 4696 { 4697 STRCPY(dst, gettail(src)); 4698 return; 4699 } 4700 4701 /* 4702 * We check both the value of the $HOME environment variable and the 4703 * "real" home directory. 4704 */ 4705 if (homedir != NULL) 4706 dirlen = STRLEN(homedir); 4707 4708 #ifdef VMS 4709 homedir_env_orig = homedir_env = mch_getenv((char_u *)"SYS$LOGIN"); 4710 #else 4711 homedir_env_orig = homedir_env = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOME"); 4712 #endif 4713 /* Empty is the same as not set. */ 4714 if (homedir_env != NULL && *homedir_env == NUL) 4715 homedir_env = NULL; 4716 4717 #if defined(FEAT_MODIFY_FNAME) || defined(FEAT_EVAL) 4718 if (homedir_env != NULL && vim_strchr(homedir_env, '~') != NULL) 4719 { 4720 int usedlen = 0; 4721 int flen; 4722 char_u *fbuf = NULL; 4723 4724 flen = (int)STRLEN(homedir_env); 4725 (void)modify_fname((char_u *)":p", &usedlen, 4726 &homedir_env, &fbuf, &flen); 4727 flen = (int)STRLEN(homedir_env); 4728 if (flen > 0 && vim_ispathsep(homedir_env[flen - 1])) 4729 /* Remove the trailing / that is added to a directory. */ 4730 homedir_env[flen - 1] = NUL; 4731 } 4732 #endif 4733 4734 if (homedir_env != NULL) 4735 envlen = STRLEN(homedir_env); 4736 4737 if (!one) 4738 src = skipwhite(src); 4739 while (*src && dstlen > 0) 4740 { 4741 /* 4742 * Here we are at the beginning of a file name. 4743 * First, check to see if the beginning of the file name matches 4744 * $HOME or the "real" home directory. Check that there is a '/' 4745 * after the match (so that if e.g. the file is "/home/pieter/bla", 4746 * and the home directory is "/home/piet", the file does not end up 4747 * as "~er/bla" (which would seem to indicate the file "bla" in user 4748 * er's home directory)). 4749 */ 4750 p = homedir; 4751 len = dirlen; 4752 for (;;) 4753 { 4754 if ( len 4755 && fnamencmp(src, p, len) == 0 4756 && (vim_ispathsep(src[len]) 4757 || (!one && (src[len] == ',' || src[len] == ' ')) 4758 || src[len] == NUL)) 4759 { 4760 src += len; 4761 if (--dstlen > 0) 4762 *dst++ = '~'; 4763 4764 /* 4765 * If it's just the home directory, add "/". 4766 */ 4767 if (!vim_ispathsep(src[0]) && --dstlen > 0) 4768 *dst++ = '/'; 4769 break; 4770 } 4771 if (p == homedir_env) 4772 break; 4773 p = homedir_env; 4774 len = envlen; 4775 } 4776 4777 /* if (!one) skip to separator: space or comma */ 4778 while (*src && (one || (*src != ',' && *src != ' ')) && --dstlen > 0) 4779 *dst++ = *src++; 4780 /* skip separator */ 4781 while ((*src == ' ' || *src == ',') && --dstlen > 0) 4782 *dst++ = *src++; 4783 } 4784 /* if (dstlen == 0) out of space, what to do??? */ 4785 4786 *dst = NUL; 4787 4788 if (homedir_env != homedir_env_orig) 4789 vim_free(homedir_env); 4790 } 4791 4792 /* 4793 * Like home_replace, store the replaced string in allocated memory. 4794 * When something fails, NULL is returned. 4795 */ 4796 char_u * 4797 home_replace_save(buf, src) 4798 buf_T *buf; /* when not NULL, check for help files */ 4799 char_u *src; /* input file name */ 4800 { 4801 char_u *dst; 4802 unsigned len; 4803 4804 len = 3; /* space for "~/" and trailing NUL */ 4805 if (src != NULL) /* just in case */ 4806 len += (unsigned)STRLEN(src); 4807 dst = alloc(len); 4808 if (dst != NULL) 4809 home_replace(buf, src, dst, len, TRUE); 4810 return dst; 4811 } 4812 4813 /* 4814 * Compare two file names and return: 4815 * FPC_SAME if they both exist and are the same file. 4816 * FPC_SAMEX if they both don't exist and have the same file name. 4817 * FPC_DIFF if they both exist and are different files. 4818 * FPC_NOTX if they both don't exist. 4819 * FPC_DIFFX if one of them doesn't exist. 4820 * For the first name environment variables are expanded 4821 */ 4822 int 4823 fullpathcmp(s1, s2, checkname) 4824 char_u *s1, *s2; 4825 int checkname; /* when both don't exist, check file names */ 4826 { 4827 #ifdef UNIX 4828 char_u exp1[MAXPATHL]; 4829 char_u full1[MAXPATHL]; 4830 char_u full2[MAXPATHL]; 4831 struct stat st1, st2; 4832 int r1, r2; 4833 4834 expand_env(s1, exp1, MAXPATHL); 4835 r1 = mch_stat((char *)exp1, &st1); 4836 r2 = mch_stat((char *)s2, &st2); 4837 if (r1 != 0 && r2 != 0) 4838 { 4839 /* if mch_stat() doesn't work, may compare the names */ 4840 if (checkname) 4841 { 4842 if (fnamecmp(exp1, s2) == 0) 4843 return FPC_SAMEX; 4844 r1 = vim_FullName(exp1, full1, MAXPATHL, FALSE); 4845 r2 = vim_FullName(s2, full2, MAXPATHL, FALSE); 4846 if (r1 == OK && r2 == OK && fnamecmp(full1, full2) == 0) 4847 return FPC_SAMEX; 4848 } 4849 return FPC_NOTX; 4850 } 4851 if (r1 != 0 || r2 != 0) 4852 return FPC_DIFFX; 4853 if (st1.st_dev == st2.st_dev && st1.st_ino == st2.st_ino) 4854 return FPC_SAME; 4855 return FPC_DIFF; 4856 #else 4857 char_u *exp1; /* expanded s1 */ 4858 char_u *full1; /* full path of s1 */ 4859 char_u *full2; /* full path of s2 */ 4860 int retval = FPC_DIFF; 4861 int r1, r2; 4862 4863 /* allocate one buffer to store three paths (alloc()/free() is slow!) */ 4864 if ((exp1 = alloc(MAXPATHL * 3)) != NULL) 4865 { 4866 full1 = exp1 + MAXPATHL; 4867 full2 = full1 + MAXPATHL; 4868 4869 expand_env(s1, exp1, MAXPATHL); 4870 r1 = vim_FullName(exp1, full1, MAXPATHL, FALSE); 4871 r2 = vim_FullName(s2, full2, MAXPATHL, FALSE); 4872 4873 /* If vim_FullName() fails, the file probably doesn't exist. */ 4874 if (r1 != OK && r2 != OK) 4875 { 4876 if (checkname && fnamecmp(exp1, s2) == 0) 4877 retval = FPC_SAMEX; 4878 else 4879 retval = FPC_NOTX; 4880 } 4881 else if (r1 != OK || r2 != OK) 4882 retval = FPC_DIFFX; 4883 else if (fnamecmp(full1, full2)) 4884 retval = FPC_DIFF; 4885 else 4886 retval = FPC_SAME; 4887 vim_free(exp1); 4888 } 4889 return retval; 4890 #endif 4891 } 4892 4893 /* 4894 * Get the tail of a path: the file name. 4895 * When the path ends in a path separator the tail is the NUL after it. 4896 * Fail safe: never returns NULL. 4897 */ 4898 char_u * 4899 gettail(fname) 4900 char_u *fname; 4901 { 4902 char_u *p1, *p2; 4903 4904 if (fname == NULL) 4905 return (char_u *)""; 4906 for (p1 = p2 = get_past_head(fname); *p2; ) /* find last part of path */ 4907 { 4908 if (vim_ispathsep_nocolon(*p2)) 4909 p1 = p2 + 1; 4910 mb_ptr_adv(p2); 4911 } 4912 return p1; 4913 } 4914 4915 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) 4916 static char_u *gettail_dir __ARGS((char_u *fname)); 4917 4918 /* 4919 * Return the end of the directory name, on the first path 4920 * separator: 4921 * "/path/file", "/path/dir/", "/path//dir", "/file" 4922 * ^ ^ ^ ^ 4923 */ 4924 static char_u * 4925 gettail_dir(fname) 4926 char_u *fname; 4927 { 4928 char_u *dir_end = fname; 4929 char_u *next_dir_end = fname; 4930 int look_for_sep = TRUE; 4931 char_u *p; 4932 4933 for (p = fname; *p != NUL; ) 4934 { 4935 if (vim_ispathsep(*p)) 4936 { 4937 if (look_for_sep) 4938 { 4939 next_dir_end = p; 4940 look_for_sep = FALSE; 4941 } 4942 } 4943 else 4944 { 4945 if (!look_for_sep) 4946 dir_end = next_dir_end; 4947 look_for_sep = TRUE; 4948 } 4949 mb_ptr_adv(p); 4950 } 4951 return dir_end; 4952 } 4953 #endif 4954 4955 /* 4956 * Get pointer to tail of "fname", including path separators. Putting a NUL 4957 * here leaves the directory name. Takes care of "c:/" and "//". 4958 * Always returns a valid pointer. 4959 */ 4960 char_u * 4961 gettail_sep(fname) 4962 char_u *fname; 4963 { 4964 char_u *p; 4965 char_u *t; 4966 4967 p = get_past_head(fname); /* don't remove the '/' from "c:/file" */ 4968 t = gettail(fname); 4969 while (t > p && after_pathsep(fname, t)) 4970 --t; 4971 #ifdef VMS 4972 /* path separator is part of the path */ 4973 ++t; 4974 #endif 4975 return t; 4976 } 4977 4978 /* 4979 * get the next path component (just after the next path separator). 4980 */ 4981 char_u * 4982 getnextcomp(fname) 4983 char_u *fname; 4984 { 4985 while (*fname && !vim_ispathsep(*fname)) 4986 mb_ptr_adv(fname); 4987 if (*fname) 4988 ++fname; 4989 return fname; 4990 } 4991 4992 /* 4993 * Get a pointer to one character past the head of a path name. 4994 * Unix: after "/"; DOS: after "c:\"; Amiga: after "disk:/"; Mac: no head. 4995 * If there is no head, path is returned. 4996 */ 4997 char_u * 4998 get_past_head(path) 4999 char_u *path; 5000 { 5001 char_u *retval; 5002 5003 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) 5004 /* may skip "c:" */ 5005 if (isalpha(path[0]) && path[1] == ':') 5006 retval = path + 2; 5007 else 5008 retval = path; 5009 #else 5010 # if defined(AMIGA) 5011 /* may skip "label:" */ 5012 retval = vim_strchr(path, ':'); 5013 if (retval == NULL) 5014 retval = path; 5015 # else /* Unix */ 5016 retval = path; 5017 # endif 5018 #endif 5019 5020 while (vim_ispathsep(*retval)) 5021 ++retval; 5022 5023 return retval; 5024 } 5025 5026 /* 5027 * Return TRUE if 'c' is a path separator. 5028 * Note that for MS-Windows this includes the colon. 5029 */ 5030 int 5031 vim_ispathsep(c) 5032 int c; 5033 { 5034 #ifdef UNIX 5035 return (c == '/'); /* UNIX has ':' inside file names */ 5036 #else 5037 # ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME 5038 return (c == ':' || c == '/' || c == '\\'); 5039 # else 5040 # ifdef VMS 5041 /* server"user passwd"::device:[full.path.name]fname.extension;version" */ 5042 return (c == ':' || c == '[' || c == ']' || c == '/' 5043 || c == '<' || c == '>' || c == '"' ); 5044 # else 5045 return (c == ':' || c == '/'); 5046 # endif /* VMS */ 5047 # endif 5048 #endif 5049 } 5050 5051 /* 5052 * Like vim_ispathsep(c), but exclude the colon for MS-Windows. 5053 */ 5054 int 5055 vim_ispathsep_nocolon(c) 5056 int c; 5057 { 5058 return vim_ispathsep(c) 5059 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME 5060 && c != ':' 5061 #endif 5062 ; 5063 } 5064 5065 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) || defined(PROTO) 5066 /* 5067 * return TRUE if 'c' is a path list separator. 5068 */ 5069 int 5070 vim_ispathlistsep(c) 5071 int c; 5072 { 5073 #ifdef UNIX 5074 return (c == ':'); 5075 #else 5076 return (c == ';'); /* might not be right for every system... */ 5077 #endif 5078 } 5079 #endif 5080 5081 #if defined(FEAT_GUI_TABLINE) || defined(FEAT_WINDOWS) \ 5082 || defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO) 5083 /* 5084 * Shorten the path of a file from "~/foo/../.bar/fname" to "~/f/../.b/fname" 5085 * It's done in-place. 5086 */ 5087 void 5088 shorten_dir(str) 5089 char_u *str; 5090 { 5091 char_u *tail, *s, *d; 5092 int skip = FALSE; 5093 5094 tail = gettail(str); 5095 d = str; 5096 for (s = str; ; ++s) 5097 { 5098 if (s >= tail) /* copy the whole tail */ 5099 { 5100 *d++ = *s; 5101 if (*s == NUL) 5102 break; 5103 } 5104 else if (vim_ispathsep(*s)) /* copy '/' and next char */ 5105 { 5106 *d++ = *s; 5107 skip = FALSE; 5108 } 5109 else if (!skip) 5110 { 5111 *d++ = *s; /* copy next char */ 5112 if (*s != '~' && *s != '.') /* and leading "~" and "." */ 5113 skip = TRUE; 5114 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 5115 if (has_mbyte) 5116 { 5117 int l = mb_ptr2len(s); 5118 5119 while (--l > 0) 5120 *d++ = *++s; 5121 } 5122 # endif 5123 } 5124 } 5125 } 5126 #endif 5127 5128 /* 5129 * Return TRUE if the directory of "fname" exists, FALSE otherwise. 5130 * Also returns TRUE if there is no directory name. 5131 * "fname" must be writable!. 5132 */ 5133 int 5134 dir_of_file_exists(fname) 5135 char_u *fname; 5136 { 5137 char_u *p; 5138 int c; 5139 int retval; 5140 5141 p = gettail_sep(fname); 5142 if (p == fname) 5143 return TRUE; 5144 c = *p; 5145 *p = NUL; 5146 retval = mch_isdir(fname); 5147 *p = c; 5148 return retval; 5149 } 5150 5151 /* 5152 * Versions of fnamecmp() and fnamencmp() that handle '/' and '\' equally 5153 * and deal with 'fileignorecase'. 5154 */ 5155 int 5156 vim_fnamecmp(x, y) 5157 char_u *x, *y; 5158 { 5159 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME 5160 return vim_fnamencmp(x, y, MAXPATHL); 5161 #else 5162 if (p_fic) 5163 return MB_STRICMP(x, y); 5164 return STRCMP(x, y); 5165 #endif 5166 } 5167 5168 int 5169 vim_fnamencmp(x, y, len) 5170 char_u *x, *y; 5171 size_t len; 5172 { 5173 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME 5174 char_u *px = x; 5175 char_u *py = y; 5176 int cx = NUL; 5177 int cy = NUL; 5178 5179 while (len > 0) 5180 { 5181 cx = PTR2CHAR(px); 5182 cy = PTR2CHAR(py); 5183 if (cx == NUL || cy == NUL 5184 || ((p_fic ? MB_TOLOWER(cx) != MB_TOLOWER(cy) : cx != cy) 5185 && !(cx == '/' && cy == '\\') 5186 && !(cx == '\\' && cy == '/'))) 5187 break; 5188 len -= MB_PTR2LEN(px); 5189 px += MB_PTR2LEN(px); 5190 py += MB_PTR2LEN(py); 5191 } 5192 if (len == 0) 5193 return 0; 5194 return (cx - cy); 5195 #else 5196 if (p_fic) 5197 return MB_STRNICMP(x, y, len); 5198 return STRNCMP(x, y, len); 5199 #endif 5200 } 5201 5202 /* 5203 * Concatenate file names fname1 and fname2 into allocated memory. 5204 * Only add a '/' or '\\' when 'sep' is TRUE and it is necessary. 5205 */ 5206 char_u * 5207 concat_fnames(fname1, fname2, sep) 5208 char_u *fname1; 5209 char_u *fname2; 5210 int sep; 5211 { 5212 char_u *dest; 5213 5214 dest = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(fname1) + STRLEN(fname2) + 3)); 5215 if (dest != NULL) 5216 { 5217 STRCPY(dest, fname1); 5218 if (sep) 5219 add_pathsep(dest); 5220 STRCAT(dest, fname2); 5221 } 5222 return dest; 5223 } 5224 5225 /* 5226 * Concatenate two strings and return the result in allocated memory. 5227 * Returns NULL when out of memory. 5228 */ 5229 char_u * 5230 concat_str(str1, str2) 5231 char_u *str1; 5232 char_u *str2; 5233 { 5234 char_u *dest; 5235 size_t l = STRLEN(str1); 5236 5237 dest = alloc((unsigned)(l + STRLEN(str2) + 1L)); 5238 if (dest != NULL) 5239 { 5240 STRCPY(dest, str1); 5241 STRCPY(dest + l, str2); 5242 } 5243 return dest; 5244 } 5245 5246 /* 5247 * Add a path separator to a file name, unless it already ends in a path 5248 * separator. 5249 */ 5250 void 5251 add_pathsep(p) 5252 char_u *p; 5253 { 5254 if (*p != NUL && !after_pathsep(p, p + STRLEN(p))) 5255 STRCAT(p, PATHSEPSTR); 5256 } 5257 5258 /* 5259 * FullName_save - Make an allocated copy of a full file name. 5260 * Returns NULL when out of memory. 5261 */ 5262 char_u * 5263 FullName_save(fname, force) 5264 char_u *fname; 5265 int force; /* force expansion, even when it already looks 5266 * like a full path name */ 5267 { 5268 char_u *buf; 5269 char_u *new_fname = NULL; 5270 5271 if (fname == NULL) 5272 return NULL; 5273 5274 buf = alloc((unsigned)MAXPATHL); 5275 if (buf != NULL) 5276 { 5277 if (vim_FullName(fname, buf, MAXPATHL, force) != FAIL) 5278 new_fname = vim_strsave(buf); 5279 else 5280 new_fname = vim_strsave(fname); 5281 vim_free(buf); 5282 } 5283 return new_fname; 5284 } 5285 5286 #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_SYN_HL) 5287 5288 static char_u *skip_string __ARGS((char_u *p)); 5289 static pos_T *ind_find_start_comment __ARGS((void)); 5290 static pos_T *ind_find_start_CORS __ARGS((void)); 5291 static pos_T *find_start_rawstring __ARGS((int ind_maxcomment)); 5292 5293 /* 5294 * Find the start of a comment, not knowing if we are in a comment right now. 5295 * Search starts at w_cursor.lnum and goes backwards. 5296 * Return NULL when not inside a comment. 5297 */ 5298 static pos_T * 5299 ind_find_start_comment() /* XXX */ 5300 { 5301 return find_start_comment(curbuf->b_ind_maxcomment); 5302 } 5303 5304 pos_T * 5305 find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment) /* XXX */ 5306 int ind_maxcomment; 5307 { 5308 pos_T *pos; 5309 char_u *line; 5310 char_u *p; 5311 int cur_maxcomment = ind_maxcomment; 5312 5313 for (;;) 5314 { 5315 pos = findmatchlimit(NULL, '*', FM_BACKWARD, cur_maxcomment); 5316 if (pos == NULL) 5317 break; 5318 5319 /* 5320 * Check if the comment start we found is inside a string. 5321 * If it is then restrict the search to below this line and try again. 5322 */ 5323 line = ml_get(pos->lnum); 5324 for (p = line; *p && (colnr_T)(p - line) < pos->col; ++p) 5325 p = skip_string(p); 5326 if ((colnr_T)(p - line) <= pos->col) 5327 break; 5328 cur_maxcomment = curwin->w_cursor.lnum - pos->lnum - 1; 5329 if (cur_maxcomment <= 0) 5330 { 5331 pos = NULL; 5332 break; 5333 } 5334 } 5335 return pos; 5336 } 5337 5338 /* 5339 * Find the start of a comment or raw string, not knowing if we are in a 5340 * comment or raw string right now. 5341 * Search starts at w_cursor.lnum and goes backwards. 5342 * Return NULL when not inside a comment or raw string. 5343 * "CORS" -> Comment Or Raw String 5344 */ 5345 static pos_T * 5346 ind_find_start_CORS() /* XXX */ 5347 { 5348 static pos_T comment_pos_copy; 5349 pos_T *comment_pos; 5350 pos_T *rs_pos; 5351 5352 comment_pos = find_start_comment(curbuf->b_ind_maxcomment); 5353 if (comment_pos != NULL) 5354 { 5355 /* Need to make a copy of the static pos in findmatchlimit(), 5356 * calling find_start_rawstring() may change it. */ 5357 comment_pos_copy = *comment_pos; 5358 comment_pos = &comment_pos_copy; 5359 } 5360 rs_pos = find_start_rawstring(curbuf->b_ind_maxcomment); 5361 5362 /* If comment_pos is before rs_pos the raw string is inside the comment. 5363 * If rs_pos is before comment_pos the comment is inside the raw string. */ 5364 if (comment_pos == NULL || (rs_pos != NULL && lt(*rs_pos, *comment_pos))) 5365 return rs_pos; 5366 return comment_pos; 5367 } 5368 5369 /* 5370 * Find the start of a raw string, not knowing if we are in one right now. 5371 * Search starts at w_cursor.lnum and goes backwards. 5372 * Return NULL when not inside a raw string. 5373 */ 5374 static pos_T * 5375 find_start_rawstring(ind_maxcomment) /* XXX */ 5376 int ind_maxcomment; 5377 { 5378 pos_T *pos; 5379 char_u *line; 5380 char_u *p; 5381 int cur_maxcomment = ind_maxcomment; 5382 5383 for (;;) 5384 { 5385 pos = findmatchlimit(NULL, 'R', FM_BACKWARD, cur_maxcomment); 5386 if (pos == NULL) 5387 break; 5388 5389 /* 5390 * Check if the raw string start we found is inside a string. 5391 * If it is then restrict the search to below this line and try again. 5392 */ 5393 line = ml_get(pos->lnum); 5394 for (p = line; *p && (colnr_T)(p - line) < pos->col; ++p) 5395 p = skip_string(p); 5396 if ((colnr_T)(p - line) <= pos->col) 5397 break; 5398 cur_maxcomment = curwin->w_cursor.lnum - pos->lnum - 1; 5399 if (cur_maxcomment <= 0) 5400 { 5401 pos = NULL; 5402 break; 5403 } 5404 } 5405 return pos; 5406 } 5407 5408 /* 5409 * Skip to the end of a "string" and a 'c' character. 5410 * If there is no string or character, return argument unmodified. 5411 */ 5412 static char_u * 5413 skip_string(p) 5414 char_u *p; 5415 { 5416 int i; 5417 5418 /* 5419 * We loop, because strings may be concatenated: "date""time". 5420 */ 5421 for ( ; ; ++p) 5422 { 5423 if (p[0] == '\'') /* 'c' or '\n' or '\000' */ 5424 { 5425 if (!p[1]) /* ' at end of line */ 5426 break; 5427 i = 2; 5428 if (p[1] == '\\') /* '\n' or '\000' */ 5429 { 5430 ++i; 5431 while (vim_isdigit(p[i - 1])) /* '\000' */ 5432 ++i; 5433 } 5434 if (p[i] == '\'') /* check for trailing ' */ 5435 { 5436 p += i; 5437 continue; 5438 } 5439 } 5440 else if (p[0] == '"') /* start of string */ 5441 { 5442 for (++p; p[0]; ++p) 5443 { 5444 if (p[0] == '\\' && p[1] != NUL) 5445 ++p; 5446 else if (p[0] == '"') /* end of string */ 5447 break; 5448 } 5449 if (p[0] == '"') 5450 continue; /* continue for another string */ 5451 } 5452 else if (p[0] == 'R' && p[1] == '"') 5453 { 5454 /* Raw string: R"[delim](...)[delim]" */ 5455 char_u *delim = p + 2; 5456 char_u *paren = vim_strchr(delim, '('); 5457 5458 if (paren != NULL) 5459 { 5460 size_t delim_len = paren - delim; 5461 5462 for (p += 3; *p; ++p) 5463 if (p[0] == ')' && STRNCMP(p + 1, delim, delim_len) == 0 5464 && p[delim_len + 1] == '"') 5465 { 5466 p += delim_len + 1; 5467 break; 5468 } 5469 if (p[0] == '"') 5470 continue; /* continue for another string */ 5471 } 5472 } 5473 break; /* no string found */ 5474 } 5475 if (!*p) 5476 --p; /* backup from NUL */ 5477 return p; 5478 } 5479 #endif /* FEAT_CINDENT || FEAT_SYN_HL */ 5480 5481 #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(PROTO) 5482 5483 /* 5484 * Do C or expression indenting on the current line. 5485 */ 5486 void 5487 do_c_expr_indent() 5488 { 5489 # ifdef FEAT_EVAL 5490 if (*curbuf->b_p_inde != NUL) 5491 fixthisline(get_expr_indent); 5492 else 5493 # endif 5494 fixthisline(get_c_indent); 5495 } 5496 5497 /* Find result cache for cpp_baseclass */ 5498 typedef struct { 5499 int found; 5500 lpos_T lpos; 5501 } cpp_baseclass_cache_T; 5502 5503 /* 5504 * Functions for C-indenting. 5505 * Most of this originally comes from Eric Fischer. 5506 */ 5507 /* 5508 * Below "XXX" means that this function may unlock the current line. 5509 */ 5510 5511 static char_u *cin_skipcomment __ARGS((char_u *)); 5512 static int cin_nocode __ARGS((char_u *)); 5513 static pos_T *find_line_comment __ARGS((void)); 5514 static int cin_has_js_key __ARGS((char_u *text)); 5515 static int cin_islabel_skip __ARGS((char_u **)); 5516 static int cin_isdefault __ARGS((char_u *)); 5517 static char_u *after_label __ARGS((char_u *l)); 5518 static int get_indent_nolabel __ARGS((linenr_T lnum)); 5519 static int skip_label __ARGS((linenr_T, char_u **pp)); 5520 static int cin_first_id_amount __ARGS((void)); 5521 static int cin_get_equal_amount __ARGS((linenr_T lnum)); 5522 static int cin_ispreproc __ARGS((char_u *)); 5523 static int cin_ispreproc_cont __ARGS((char_u **pp, linenr_T *lnump)); 5524 static int cin_iscomment __ARGS((char_u *)); 5525 static int cin_islinecomment __ARGS((char_u *)); 5526 static int cin_isterminated __ARGS((char_u *, int, int)); 5527 static int cin_isinit __ARGS((void)); 5528 static int cin_isfuncdecl __ARGS((char_u **, linenr_T, linenr_T)); 5529 static int cin_isif __ARGS((char_u *)); 5530 static int cin_iselse __ARGS((char_u *)); 5531 static int cin_isdo __ARGS((char_u *)); 5532 static int cin_iswhileofdo __ARGS((char_u *, linenr_T)); 5533 static int cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset __ARGS((char_u *line, int *poffset)); 5534 static int cin_iswhileofdo_end __ARGS((int terminated)); 5535 static int cin_isbreak __ARGS((char_u *)); 5536 static int cin_is_cpp_baseclass __ARGS((cpp_baseclass_cache_T *cached)); 5537 static int get_baseclass_amount __ARGS((int col)); 5538 static int cin_ends_in __ARGS((char_u *, char_u *, char_u *)); 5539 static int cin_starts_with __ARGS((char_u *s, char *word)); 5540 static int cin_skip2pos __ARGS((pos_T *trypos)); 5541 static pos_T *find_start_brace __ARGS((void)); 5542 static pos_T *find_match_paren __ARGS((int)); 5543 static pos_T *find_match_char __ARGS((int c, int ind_maxparen)); 5544 static int corr_ind_maxparen __ARGS((pos_T *startpos)); 5545 static int find_last_paren __ARGS((char_u *l, int start, int end)); 5546 static int find_match __ARGS((int lookfor, linenr_T ourscope)); 5547 static int cin_is_cpp_namespace __ARGS((char_u *)); 5548 5549 /* 5550 * Skip over white space and C comments within the line. 5551 * Also skip over Perl/shell comments if desired. 5552 */ 5553 static char_u * 5554 cin_skipcomment(s) 5555 char_u *s; 5556 { 5557 while (*s) 5558 { 5559 char_u *prev_s = s; 5560 5561 s = skipwhite(s); 5562 5563 /* Perl/shell # comment comment continues until eol. Require a space 5564 * before # to avoid recognizing $#array. */ 5565 if (curbuf->b_ind_hash_comment != 0 && s != prev_s && *s == '#') 5566 { 5567 s += STRLEN(s); 5568 break; 5569 } 5570 if (*s != '/') 5571 break; 5572 ++s; 5573 if (*s == '/') /* slash-slash comment continues till eol */ 5574 { 5575 s += STRLEN(s); 5576 break; 5577 } 5578 if (*s != '*') 5579 break; 5580 for (++s; *s; ++s) /* skip slash-star comment */ 5581 if (s[0] == '*' && s[1] == '/') 5582 { 5583 s += 2; 5584 break; 5585 } 5586 } 5587 return s; 5588 } 5589 5590 /* 5591 * Return TRUE if there is no code at *s. White space and comments are 5592 * not considered code. 5593 */ 5594 static int 5595 cin_nocode(s) 5596 char_u *s; 5597 { 5598 return *cin_skipcomment(s) == NUL; 5599 } 5600 5601 /* 5602 * Check previous lines for a "//" line comment, skipping over blank lines. 5603 */ 5604 static pos_T * 5605 find_line_comment() /* XXX */ 5606 { 5607 static pos_T pos; 5608 char_u *line; 5609 char_u *p; 5610 5611 pos = curwin->w_cursor; 5612 while (--pos.lnum > 0) 5613 { 5614 line = ml_get(pos.lnum); 5615 p = skipwhite(line); 5616 if (cin_islinecomment(p)) 5617 { 5618 pos.col = (int)(p - line); 5619 return &pos; 5620 } 5621 if (*p != NUL) 5622 break; 5623 } 5624 return NULL; 5625 } 5626 5627 /* 5628 * Return TRUE if "text" starts with "key:". 5629 */ 5630 static int 5631 cin_has_js_key(text) 5632 char_u *text; 5633 { 5634 char_u *s = skipwhite(text); 5635 int quote = -1; 5636 5637 if (*s == '\'' || *s == '"') 5638 { 5639 /* can be 'key': or "key": */ 5640 quote = *s; 5641 ++s; 5642 } 5643 if (!vim_isIDc(*s)) /* need at least one ID character */ 5644 return FALSE; 5645 5646 while (vim_isIDc(*s)) 5647 ++s; 5648 if (*s == quote) 5649 ++s; 5650 5651 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 5652 5653 /* "::" is not a label, it's C++ */ 5654 return (*s == ':' && s[1] != ':'); 5655 } 5656 5657 /* 5658 * Check if string matches "label:"; move to character after ':' if true. 5659 * "*s" must point to the start of the label, if there is one. 5660 */ 5661 static int 5662 cin_islabel_skip(s) 5663 char_u **s; 5664 { 5665 if (!vim_isIDc(**s)) /* need at least one ID character */ 5666 return FALSE; 5667 5668 while (vim_isIDc(**s)) 5669 (*s)++; 5670 5671 *s = cin_skipcomment(*s); 5672 5673 /* "::" is not a label, it's C++ */ 5674 return (**s == ':' && *++*s != ':'); 5675 } 5676 5677 /* 5678 * Recognize a label: "label:". 5679 * Note: curwin->w_cursor must be where we are looking for the label. 5680 */ 5681 int 5682 cin_islabel() /* XXX */ 5683 { 5684 char_u *s; 5685 5686 s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); 5687 5688 /* 5689 * Exclude "default" from labels, since it should be indented 5690 * like a switch label. Same for C++ scope declarations. 5691 */ 5692 if (cin_isdefault(s)) 5693 return FALSE; 5694 if (cin_isscopedecl(s)) 5695 return FALSE; 5696 5697 if (cin_islabel_skip(&s)) 5698 { 5699 /* 5700 * Only accept a label if the previous line is terminated or is a case 5701 * label. 5702 */ 5703 pos_T cursor_save; 5704 pos_T *trypos; 5705 char_u *line; 5706 5707 cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; 5708 while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) 5709 { 5710 --curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 5711 5712 /* 5713 * If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip to the start of 5714 * it. 5715 */ 5716 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 5717 if ((trypos = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL) /* XXX */ 5718 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 5719 5720 line = ml_get_curline(); 5721 if (cin_ispreproc(line)) /* ignore #defines, #if, etc. */ 5722 continue; 5723 if (*(line = cin_skipcomment(line)) == NUL) 5724 continue; 5725 5726 curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; 5727 if (cin_isterminated(line, TRUE, FALSE) 5728 || cin_isscopedecl(line) 5729 || cin_iscase(line, TRUE) 5730 || (cin_islabel_skip(&line) && cin_nocode(line))) 5731 return TRUE; 5732 return FALSE; 5733 } 5734 curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; 5735 return TRUE; /* label at start of file??? */ 5736 } 5737 return FALSE; 5738 } 5739 5740 /* 5741 * Recognize structure initialization and enumerations: 5742 * "[typedef] [static|public|protected|private] enum" 5743 * "[typedef] [static|public|protected|private] = {" 5744 */ 5745 static int 5746 cin_isinit(void) 5747 { 5748 char_u *s; 5749 static char *skip[] = {"static", "public", "protected", "private"}; 5750 5751 s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); 5752 5753 if (cin_starts_with(s, "typedef")) 5754 s = cin_skipcomment(s + 7); 5755 5756 for (;;) 5757 { 5758 int i, l; 5759 5760 for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(skip) / sizeof(char *)); ++i) 5761 { 5762 l = (int)strlen(skip[i]); 5763 if (cin_starts_with(s, skip[i])) 5764 { 5765 s = cin_skipcomment(s + l); 5766 l = 0; 5767 break; 5768 } 5769 } 5770 if (l != 0) 5771 break; 5772 } 5773 5774 if (cin_starts_with(s, "enum")) 5775 return TRUE; 5776 5777 if (cin_ends_in(s, (char_u *)"=", (char_u *)"{")) 5778 return TRUE; 5779 5780 return FALSE; 5781 } 5782 5783 /* 5784 * Recognize a switch label: "case .*:" or "default:". 5785 */ 5786 int 5787 cin_iscase(s, strict) 5788 char_u *s; 5789 int strict; /* Allow relaxed check of case statement for JS */ 5790 { 5791 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 5792 if (cin_starts_with(s, "case")) 5793 { 5794 for (s += 4; *s; ++s) 5795 { 5796 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 5797 if (*s == ':') 5798 { 5799 if (s[1] == ':') /* skip over "::" for C++ */ 5800 ++s; 5801 else 5802 return TRUE; 5803 } 5804 if (*s == '\'' && s[1] && s[2] == '\'') 5805 s += 2; /* skip over ':' */ 5806 else if (*s == '/' && (s[1] == '*' || s[1] == '/')) 5807 return FALSE; /* stop at comment */ 5808 else if (*s == '"') 5809 { 5810 /* JS etc. */ 5811 if (strict) 5812 return FALSE; /* stop at string */ 5813 else 5814 return TRUE; 5815 } 5816 } 5817 return FALSE; 5818 } 5819 5820 if (cin_isdefault(s)) 5821 return TRUE; 5822 return FALSE; 5823 } 5824 5825 /* 5826 * Recognize a "default" switch label. 5827 */ 5828 static int 5829 cin_isdefault(s) 5830 char_u *s; 5831 { 5832 return (STRNCMP(s, "default", 7) == 0 5833 && *(s = cin_skipcomment(s + 7)) == ':' 5834 && s[1] != ':'); 5835 } 5836 5837 /* 5838 * Recognize a "public/private/protected" scope declaration label. 5839 */ 5840 int 5841 cin_isscopedecl(s) 5842 char_u *s; 5843 { 5844 int i; 5845 5846 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 5847 if (STRNCMP(s, "public", 6) == 0) 5848 i = 6; 5849 else if (STRNCMP(s, "protected", 9) == 0) 5850 i = 9; 5851 else if (STRNCMP(s, "private", 7) == 0) 5852 i = 7; 5853 else 5854 return FALSE; 5855 return (*(s = cin_skipcomment(s + i)) == ':' && s[1] != ':'); 5856 } 5857 5858 /* Maximum number of lines to search back for a "namespace" line. */ 5859 #define FIND_NAMESPACE_LIM 20 5860 5861 /* 5862 * Recognize a "namespace" scope declaration. 5863 */ 5864 static int 5865 cin_is_cpp_namespace(s) 5866 char_u *s; 5867 { 5868 char_u *p; 5869 int has_name = FALSE; 5870 5871 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 5872 if (STRNCMP(s, "namespace", 9) == 0 && (s[9] == NUL || !vim_iswordc(s[9]))) 5873 { 5874 p = cin_skipcomment(skipwhite(s + 9)); 5875 while (*p != NUL) 5876 { 5877 if (vim_iswhite(*p)) 5878 { 5879 has_name = TRUE; /* found end of a name */ 5880 p = cin_skipcomment(skipwhite(p)); 5881 } 5882 else if (*p == '{') 5883 { 5884 break; 5885 } 5886 else if (vim_iswordc(*p)) 5887 { 5888 if (has_name) 5889 return FALSE; /* word character after skipping past name */ 5890 ++p; 5891 } 5892 else 5893 { 5894 return FALSE; 5895 } 5896 } 5897 return TRUE; 5898 } 5899 return FALSE; 5900 } 5901 5902 /* 5903 * Return a pointer to the first non-empty non-comment character after a ':'. 5904 * Return NULL if not found. 5905 * case 234: a = b; 5906 * ^ 5907 */ 5908 static char_u * 5909 after_label(l) 5910 char_u *l; 5911 { 5912 for ( ; *l; ++l) 5913 { 5914 if (*l == ':') 5915 { 5916 if (l[1] == ':') /* skip over "::" for C++ */ 5917 ++l; 5918 else if (!cin_iscase(l + 1, FALSE)) 5919 break; 5920 } 5921 else if (*l == '\'' && l[1] && l[2] == '\'') 5922 l += 2; /* skip over 'x' */ 5923 } 5924 if (*l == NUL) 5925 return NULL; 5926 l = cin_skipcomment(l + 1); 5927 if (*l == NUL) 5928 return NULL; 5929 return l; 5930 } 5931 5932 /* 5933 * Get indent of line "lnum", skipping a label. 5934 * Return 0 if there is nothing after the label. 5935 */ 5936 static int 5937 get_indent_nolabel(lnum) /* XXX */ 5938 linenr_T lnum; 5939 { 5940 char_u *l; 5941 pos_T fp; 5942 colnr_T col; 5943 char_u *p; 5944 5945 l = ml_get(lnum); 5946 p = after_label(l); 5947 if (p == NULL) 5948 return 0; 5949 5950 fp.col = (colnr_T)(p - l); 5951 fp.lnum = lnum; 5952 getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL); 5953 return (int)col; 5954 } 5955 5956 /* 5957 * Find indent for line "lnum", ignoring any case or jump label. 5958 * Also return a pointer to the text (after the label) in "pp". 5959 * label: if (asdf && asdfasdf) 5960 * ^ 5961 */ 5962 static int 5963 skip_label(lnum, pp) 5964 linenr_T lnum; 5965 char_u **pp; 5966 { 5967 char_u *l; 5968 int amount; 5969 pos_T cursor_save; 5970 5971 cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; 5972 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum; 5973 l = ml_get_curline(); 5974 /* XXX */ 5975 if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l) || cin_islabel()) 5976 { 5977 amount = get_indent_nolabel(lnum); 5978 l = after_label(ml_get_curline()); 5979 if (l == NULL) /* just in case */ 5980 l = ml_get_curline(); 5981 } 5982 else 5983 { 5984 amount = get_indent(); 5985 l = ml_get_curline(); 5986 } 5987 *pp = l; 5988 5989 curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; 5990 return amount; 5991 } 5992 5993 /* 5994 * Return the indent of the first variable name after a type in a declaration. 5995 * int a, indent of "a" 5996 * static struct foo b, indent of "b" 5997 * enum bla c, indent of "c" 5998 * Returns zero when it doesn't look like a declaration. 5999 */ 6000 static int 6001 cin_first_id_amount() 6002 { 6003 char_u *line, *p, *s; 6004 int len; 6005 pos_T fp; 6006 colnr_T col; 6007 6008 line = ml_get_curline(); 6009 p = skipwhite(line); 6010 len = (int)(skiptowhite(p) - p); 6011 if (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "static", 6) == 0) 6012 { 6013 p = skipwhite(p + 6); 6014 len = (int)(skiptowhite(p) - p); 6015 } 6016 if (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "struct", 6) == 0) 6017 p = skipwhite(p + 6); 6018 else if (len == 4 && STRNCMP(p, "enum", 4) == 0) 6019 p = skipwhite(p + 4); 6020 else if ((len == 8 && STRNCMP(p, "unsigned", 8) == 0) 6021 || (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "signed", 6) == 0)) 6022 { 6023 s = skipwhite(p + len); 6024 if ((STRNCMP(s, "int", 3) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[3])) 6025 || (STRNCMP(s, "long", 4) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[4])) 6026 || (STRNCMP(s, "short", 5) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[5])) 6027 || (STRNCMP(s, "char", 4) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[4]))) 6028 p = s; 6029 } 6030 for (len = 0; vim_isIDc(p[len]); ++len) 6031 ; 6032 if (len == 0 || !vim_iswhite(p[len]) || cin_nocode(p)) 6033 return 0; 6034 6035 p = skipwhite(p + len); 6036 fp.lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 6037 fp.col = (colnr_T)(p - line); 6038 getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL); 6039 return (int)col; 6040 } 6041 6042 /* 6043 * Return the indent of the first non-blank after an equal sign. 6044 * char *foo = "here"; 6045 * Return zero if no (useful) equal sign found. 6046 * Return -1 if the line above "lnum" ends in a backslash. 6047 * foo = "asdf\ 6048 * asdf\ 6049 * here"; 6050 */ 6051 static int 6052 cin_get_equal_amount(lnum) 6053 linenr_T lnum; 6054 { 6055 char_u *line; 6056 char_u *s; 6057 colnr_T col; 6058 pos_T fp; 6059 6060 if (lnum > 1) 6061 { 6062 line = ml_get(lnum - 1); 6063 if (*line != NUL && line[STRLEN(line) - 1] == '\\') 6064 return -1; 6065 } 6066 6067 line = s = ml_get(lnum); 6068 while (*s != NUL && vim_strchr((char_u *)"=;{}\"'", *s) == NULL) 6069 { 6070 if (cin_iscomment(s)) /* ignore comments */ 6071 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 6072 else 6073 ++s; 6074 } 6075 if (*s != '=') 6076 return 0; 6077 6078 s = skipwhite(s + 1); 6079 if (cin_nocode(s)) 6080 return 0; 6081 6082 if (*s == '"') /* nice alignment for continued strings */ 6083 ++s; 6084 6085 fp.lnum = lnum; 6086 fp.col = (colnr_T)(s - line); 6087 getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL); 6088 return (int)col; 6089 } 6090 6091 /* 6092 * Recognize a preprocessor statement: Any line that starts with '#'. 6093 */ 6094 static int 6095 cin_ispreproc(s) 6096 char_u *s; 6097 { 6098 if (*skipwhite(s) == '#') 6099 return TRUE; 6100 return FALSE; 6101 } 6102 6103 /* 6104 * Return TRUE if line "*pp" at "*lnump" is a preprocessor statement or a 6105 * continuation line of a preprocessor statement. Decrease "*lnump" to the 6106 * start and return the line in "*pp". 6107 */ 6108 static int 6109 cin_ispreproc_cont(pp, lnump) 6110 char_u **pp; 6111 linenr_T *lnump; 6112 { 6113 char_u *line = *pp; 6114 linenr_T lnum = *lnump; 6115 int retval = FALSE; 6116 6117 for (;;) 6118 { 6119 if (cin_ispreproc(line)) 6120 { 6121 retval = TRUE; 6122 *lnump = lnum; 6123 break; 6124 } 6125 if (lnum == 1) 6126 break; 6127 line = ml_get(--lnum); 6128 if (*line == NUL || line[STRLEN(line) - 1] != '\\') 6129 break; 6130 } 6131 6132 if (lnum != *lnump) 6133 *pp = ml_get(*lnump); 6134 return retval; 6135 } 6136 6137 /* 6138 * Recognize the start of a C or C++ comment. 6139 */ 6140 static int 6141 cin_iscomment(p) 6142 char_u *p; 6143 { 6144 return (p[0] == '/' && (p[1] == '*' || p[1] == '/')); 6145 } 6146 6147 /* 6148 * Recognize the start of a "//" comment. 6149 */ 6150 static int 6151 cin_islinecomment(p) 6152 char_u *p; 6153 { 6154 return (p[0] == '/' && p[1] == '/'); 6155 } 6156 6157 /* 6158 * Recognize a line that starts with '{' or '}', or ends with ';', ',', '{' or 6159 * '}'. 6160 * Don't consider "} else" a terminated line. 6161 * If a line begins with an "else", only consider it terminated if no unmatched 6162 * opening braces follow (handle "else { foo();" correctly). 6163 * Return the character terminating the line (ending char's have precedence if 6164 * both apply in order to determine initializations). 6165 */ 6166 static int 6167 cin_isterminated(s, incl_open, incl_comma) 6168 char_u *s; 6169 int incl_open; /* include '{' at the end as terminator */ 6170 int incl_comma; /* recognize a trailing comma */ 6171 { 6172 char_u found_start = 0; 6173 unsigned n_open = 0; 6174 int is_else = FALSE; 6175 6176 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 6177 6178 if (*s == '{' || (*s == '}' && !cin_iselse(s))) 6179 found_start = *s; 6180 6181 if (!found_start) 6182 is_else = cin_iselse(s); 6183 6184 while (*s) 6185 { 6186 /* skip over comments, "" strings and 'c'haracters */ 6187 s = skip_string(cin_skipcomment(s)); 6188 if (*s == '}' && n_open > 0) 6189 --n_open; 6190 if ((!is_else || n_open == 0) 6191 && (*s == ';' || *s == '}' || (incl_comma && *s == ',')) 6192 && cin_nocode(s + 1)) 6193 return *s; 6194 else if (*s == '{') 6195 { 6196 if (incl_open && cin_nocode(s + 1)) 6197 return *s; 6198 else 6199 ++n_open; 6200 } 6201 6202 if (*s) 6203 s++; 6204 } 6205 return found_start; 6206 } 6207 6208 /* 6209 * Recognize the basic picture of a function declaration -- it needs to 6210 * have an open paren somewhere and a close paren at the end of the line and 6211 * no semicolons anywhere. 6212 * When a line ends in a comma we continue looking in the next line. 6213 * "sp" points to a string with the line. When looking at other lines it must 6214 * be restored to the line. When it's NULL fetch lines here. 6215 * "lnum" is where we start looking. 6216 * "min_lnum" is the line before which we will not be looking. 6217 */ 6218 static int 6219 cin_isfuncdecl(sp, first_lnum, min_lnum) 6220 char_u **sp; 6221 linenr_T first_lnum; 6222 linenr_T min_lnum; 6223 { 6224 char_u *s; 6225 linenr_T lnum = first_lnum; 6226 int retval = FALSE; 6227 pos_T *trypos; 6228 int just_started = TRUE; 6229 6230 if (sp == NULL) 6231 s = ml_get(lnum); 6232 else 6233 s = *sp; 6234 6235 if (find_last_paren(s, '(', ')') 6236 && (trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL) 6237 { 6238 lnum = trypos->lnum; 6239 if (lnum < min_lnum) 6240 return FALSE; 6241 6242 s = ml_get(lnum); 6243 } 6244 6245 /* Ignore line starting with #. */ 6246 if (cin_ispreproc(s)) 6247 return FALSE; 6248 6249 while (*s && *s != '(' && *s != ';' && *s != '\'' && *s != '"') 6250 { 6251 if (cin_iscomment(s)) /* ignore comments */ 6252 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 6253 else if (*s == ':') 6254 { 6255 if (*(s + 1) == ':') 6256 s += 2; 6257 else 6258 /* To avoid a mistake in the following situation: 6259 * A::A(int a, int b) 6260 * : a(0) // <--not a function decl 6261 * , b(0) 6262 * {... 6263 */ 6264 return FALSE; 6265 } 6266 else 6267 ++s; 6268 } 6269 if (*s != '(') 6270 return FALSE; /* ';', ' or " before any () or no '(' */ 6271 6272 while (*s && *s != ';' && *s != '\'' && *s != '"') 6273 { 6274 if (*s == ')' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) 6275 { 6276 /* ')' at the end: may have found a match 6277 * Check for he previous line not to end in a backslash: 6278 * #if defined(x) && \ 6279 * defined(y) 6280 */ 6281 lnum = first_lnum - 1; 6282 s = ml_get(lnum); 6283 if (*s == NUL || s[STRLEN(s) - 1] != '\\') 6284 retval = TRUE; 6285 goto done; 6286 } 6287 if ((*s == ',' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) || s[1] == NUL || cin_nocode(s)) 6288 { 6289 int comma = (*s == ','); 6290 6291 /* ',' at the end: continue looking in the next line. 6292 * At the end: check for ',' in the next line, for this style: 6293 * func(arg1 6294 * , arg2) */ 6295 for (;;) 6296 { 6297 if (lnum >= curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) 6298 break; 6299 s = ml_get(++lnum); 6300 if (!cin_ispreproc(s)) 6301 break; 6302 } 6303 if (lnum >= curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) 6304 break; 6305 /* Require a comma at end of the line or a comma or ')' at the 6306 * start of next line. */ 6307 s = skipwhite(s); 6308 if (!just_started && (!comma && *s != ',' && *s != ')')) 6309 break; 6310 just_started = FALSE; 6311 } 6312 else if (cin_iscomment(s)) /* ignore comments */ 6313 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 6314 else 6315 { 6316 ++s; 6317 just_started = FALSE; 6318 } 6319 } 6320 6321 done: 6322 if (lnum != first_lnum && sp != NULL) 6323 *sp = ml_get(first_lnum); 6324 6325 return retval; 6326 } 6327 6328 static int 6329 cin_isif(p) 6330 char_u *p; 6331 { 6332 return (STRNCMP(p, "if", 2) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[2])); 6333 } 6334 6335 static int 6336 cin_iselse(p) 6337 char_u *p; 6338 { 6339 if (*p == '}') /* accept "} else" */ 6340 p = cin_skipcomment(p + 1); 6341 return (STRNCMP(p, "else", 4) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[4])); 6342 } 6343 6344 static int 6345 cin_isdo(p) 6346 char_u *p; 6347 { 6348 return (STRNCMP(p, "do", 2) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[2])); 6349 } 6350 6351 /* 6352 * Check if this is a "while" that should have a matching "do". 6353 * We only accept a "while (condition) ;", with only white space between the 6354 * ')' and ';'. The condition may be spread over several lines. 6355 */ 6356 static int 6357 cin_iswhileofdo(p, lnum) /* XXX */ 6358 char_u *p; 6359 linenr_T lnum; 6360 { 6361 pos_T cursor_save; 6362 pos_T *trypos; 6363 int retval = FALSE; 6364 6365 p = cin_skipcomment(p); 6366 if (*p == '}') /* accept "} while (cond);" */ 6367 p = cin_skipcomment(p + 1); 6368 if (cin_starts_with(p, "while")) 6369 { 6370 cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; 6371 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum; 6372 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 6373 p = ml_get_curline(); 6374 while (*p && *p != 'w') /* skip any '}', until the 'w' of the "while" */ 6375 { 6376 ++p; 6377 ++curwin->w_cursor.col; 6378 } 6379 if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, 0, 0, 6380 curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL 6381 && *cin_skipcomment(ml_get_pos(trypos) + 1) == ';') 6382 retval = TRUE; 6383 curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; 6384 } 6385 return retval; 6386 } 6387 6388 /* 6389 * Check whether in "p" there is an "if", "for" or "while" before "*poffset". 6390 * Return 0 if there is none. 6391 * Otherwise return !0 and update "*poffset" to point to the place where the 6392 * string was found. 6393 */ 6394 static int 6395 cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset(line, poffset) 6396 char_u *line; 6397 int *poffset; 6398 { 6399 int offset = *poffset; 6400 6401 if (offset-- < 2) 6402 return 0; 6403 while (offset > 2 && vim_iswhite(line[offset])) 6404 --offset; 6405 6406 offset -= 1; 6407 if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "if", 2)) 6408 goto probablyFound; 6409 6410 if (offset >= 1) 6411 { 6412 offset -= 1; 6413 if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "for", 3)) 6414 goto probablyFound; 6415 6416 if (offset >= 2) 6417 { 6418 offset -= 2; 6419 if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "while", 5)) 6420 goto probablyFound; 6421 } 6422 } 6423 return 0; 6424 6425 probablyFound: 6426 if (!offset || !vim_isIDc(line[offset - 1])) 6427 { 6428 *poffset = offset; 6429 return 1; 6430 } 6431 return 0; 6432 } 6433 6434 /* 6435 * Return TRUE if we are at the end of a do-while. 6436 * do 6437 * nothing; 6438 * while (foo 6439 * && bar); <-- here 6440 * Adjust the cursor to the line with "while". 6441 */ 6442 static int 6443 cin_iswhileofdo_end(terminated) 6444 int terminated; 6445 { 6446 char_u *line; 6447 char_u *p; 6448 char_u *s; 6449 pos_T *trypos; 6450 int i; 6451 6452 if (terminated != ';') /* there must be a ';' at the end */ 6453 return FALSE; 6454 6455 p = line = ml_get_curline(); 6456 while (*p != NUL) 6457 { 6458 p = cin_skipcomment(p); 6459 if (*p == ')') 6460 { 6461 s = skipwhite(p + 1); 6462 if (*s == ';' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) 6463 { 6464 /* Found ");" at end of the line, now check there is "while" 6465 * before the matching '('. XXX */ 6466 i = (int)(p - line); 6467 curwin->w_cursor.col = i; 6468 trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen); 6469 if (trypos != NULL) 6470 { 6471 s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get(trypos->lnum)); 6472 if (*s == '}') /* accept "} while (cond);" */ 6473 s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1); 6474 if (cin_starts_with(s, "while")) 6475 { 6476 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum; 6477 return TRUE; 6478 } 6479 } 6480 6481 /* Searching may have made "line" invalid, get it again. */ 6482 line = ml_get_curline(); 6483 p = line + i; 6484 } 6485 } 6486 if (*p != NUL) 6487 ++p; 6488 } 6489 return FALSE; 6490 } 6491 6492 static int 6493 cin_isbreak(p) 6494 char_u *p; 6495 { 6496 return (STRNCMP(p, "break", 5) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[5])); 6497 } 6498 6499 /* 6500 * Find the position of a C++ base-class declaration or 6501 * constructor-initialization. eg: 6502 * 6503 * class MyClass : 6504 * baseClass <-- here 6505 * class MyClass : public baseClass, 6506 * anotherBaseClass <-- here (should probably lineup ??) 6507 * MyClass::MyClass(...) : 6508 * baseClass(...) <-- here (constructor-initialization) 6509 * 6510 * This is a lot of guessing. Watch out for "cond ? func() : foo". 6511 */ 6512 static int 6513 cin_is_cpp_baseclass(cached) 6514 cpp_baseclass_cache_T *cached; /* input and output */ 6515 { 6516 lpos_T *pos = &cached->lpos; /* find position */ 6517 char_u *s; 6518 int class_or_struct, lookfor_ctor_init, cpp_base_class; 6519 linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 6520 char_u *line = ml_get_curline(); 6521 6522 if (pos->lnum <= lnum) 6523 return cached->found; /* Use the cached result */ 6524 6525 pos->col = 0; 6526 6527 s = skipwhite(line); 6528 if (*s == '#') /* skip #define FOO x ? (x) : x */ 6529 return FALSE; 6530 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 6531 if (*s == NUL) 6532 return FALSE; 6533 6534 cpp_base_class = lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE; 6535 6536 /* Search for a line starting with '#', empty, ending in ';' or containing 6537 * '{' or '}' and start below it. This handles the following situations: 6538 * a = cond ? 6539 * func() : 6540 * asdf; 6541 * func::foo() 6542 * : something 6543 * {} 6544 * Foo::Foo (int one, int two) 6545 * : something(4), 6546 * somethingelse(3) 6547 * {} 6548 */ 6549 while (lnum > 1) 6550 { 6551 line = ml_get(lnum - 1); 6552 s = skipwhite(line); 6553 if (*s == '#' || *s == NUL) 6554 break; 6555 while (*s != NUL) 6556 { 6557 s = cin_skipcomment(s); 6558 if (*s == '{' || *s == '}' 6559 || (*s == ';' && cin_nocode(s + 1))) 6560 break; 6561 if (*s != NUL) 6562 ++s; 6563 } 6564 if (*s != NUL) 6565 break; 6566 --lnum; 6567 } 6568 6569 pos->lnum = lnum; 6570 line = ml_get(lnum); 6571 s = line; 6572 for (;;) 6573 { 6574 if (*s == NUL) 6575 { 6576 if (lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum) 6577 break; 6578 /* Continue in the cursor line. */ 6579 line = ml_get(++lnum); 6580 s = line; 6581 } 6582 if (s == line) 6583 { 6584 /* don't recognize "case (foo):" as a baseclass */ 6585 if (cin_iscase(s, FALSE)) 6586 break; 6587 s = cin_skipcomment(line); 6588 if (*s == NUL) 6589 continue; 6590 } 6591 6592 if (s[0] == '"' || (s[0] == 'R' && s[1] == '"')) 6593 s = skip_string(s) + 1; 6594 else if (s[0] == ':') 6595 { 6596 if (s[1] == ':') 6597 { 6598 /* skip double colon. It can't be a constructor 6599 * initialization any more */ 6600 lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE; 6601 s = cin_skipcomment(s + 2); 6602 } 6603 else if (lookfor_ctor_init || class_or_struct) 6604 { 6605 /* we have something found, that looks like the start of 6606 * cpp-base-class-declaration or constructor-initialization */ 6607 cpp_base_class = TRUE; 6608 lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE; 6609 pos->col = 0; 6610 s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1); 6611 } 6612 else 6613 s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1); 6614 } 6615 else if ((STRNCMP(s, "class", 5) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[5])) 6616 || (STRNCMP(s, "struct", 6) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[6]))) 6617 { 6618 class_or_struct = TRUE; 6619 lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE; 6620 6621 if (*s == 'c') 6622 s = cin_skipcomment(s + 5); 6623 else 6624 s = cin_skipcomment(s + 6); 6625 } 6626 else 6627 { 6628 if (s[0] == '{' || s[0] == '}' || s[0] == ';') 6629 { 6630 cpp_base_class = lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE; 6631 } 6632 else if (s[0] == ')') 6633 { 6634 /* Constructor-initialization is assumed if we come across 6635 * something like "):" */ 6636 class_or_struct = FALSE; 6637 lookfor_ctor_init = TRUE; 6638 } 6639 else if (s[0] == '?') 6640 { 6641 /* Avoid seeing '() :' after '?' as constructor init. */ 6642 return FALSE; 6643 } 6644 else if (!vim_isIDc(s[0])) 6645 { 6646 /* if it is not an identifier, we are wrong */ 6647 class_or_struct = FALSE; 6648 lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE; 6649 } 6650 else if (pos->col == 0) 6651 { 6652 /* it can't be a constructor-initialization any more */ 6653 lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE; 6654 6655 /* the first statement starts here: lineup with this one... */ 6656 if (cpp_base_class) 6657 pos->col = (colnr_T)(s - line); 6658 } 6659 6660 /* When the line ends in a comma don't align with it. */ 6661 if (lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum && *s == ',' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) 6662 pos->col = 0; 6663 6664 s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1); 6665 } 6666 } 6667 6668 cached->found = cpp_base_class; 6669 if (cpp_base_class) 6670 pos->lnum = lnum; 6671 return cpp_base_class; 6672 } 6673 6674 static int 6675 get_baseclass_amount(col) 6676 int col; 6677 { 6678 int amount; 6679 colnr_T vcol; 6680 pos_T *trypos; 6681 6682 if (col == 0) 6683 { 6684 amount = get_indent(); 6685 if (find_last_paren(ml_get_curline(), '(', ')') 6686 && (trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL) 6687 amount = get_indent_lnum(trypos->lnum); /* XXX */ 6688 if (!cin_ends_in(ml_get_curline(), (char_u *)",", NULL)) 6689 amount += curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass; 6690 } 6691 else 6692 { 6693 curwin->w_cursor.col = col; 6694 getvcol(curwin, &curwin->w_cursor, &vcol, NULL, NULL); 6695 amount = (int)vcol; 6696 } 6697 if (amount < curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass) 6698 amount = curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass; 6699 return amount; 6700 } 6701 6702 /* 6703 * Return TRUE if string "s" ends with the string "find", possibly followed by 6704 * white space and comments. Skip strings and comments. 6705 * Ignore "ignore" after "find" if it's not NULL. 6706 */ 6707 static int 6708 cin_ends_in(s, find, ignore) 6709 char_u *s; 6710 char_u *find; 6711 char_u *ignore; 6712 { 6713 char_u *p = s; 6714 char_u *r; 6715 int len = (int)STRLEN(find); 6716 6717 while (*p != NUL) 6718 { 6719 p = cin_skipcomment(p); 6720 if (STRNCMP(p, find, len) == 0) 6721 { 6722 r = skipwhite(p + len); 6723 if (ignore != NULL && STRNCMP(r, ignore, STRLEN(ignore)) == 0) 6724 r = skipwhite(r + STRLEN(ignore)); 6725 if (cin_nocode(r)) 6726 return TRUE; 6727 } 6728 if (*p != NUL) 6729 ++p; 6730 } 6731 return FALSE; 6732 } 6733 6734 /* 6735 * Return TRUE when "s" starts with "word" and then a non-ID character. 6736 */ 6737 static int 6738 cin_starts_with(s, word) 6739 char_u *s; 6740 char *word; 6741 { 6742 int l = (int)STRLEN(word); 6743 6744 return (STRNCMP(s, word, l) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[l])); 6745 } 6746 6747 /* 6748 * Skip strings, chars and comments until at or past "trypos". 6749 * Return the column found. 6750 */ 6751 static int 6752 cin_skip2pos(trypos) 6753 pos_T *trypos; 6754 { 6755 char_u *line; 6756 char_u *p; 6757 6758 p = line = ml_get(trypos->lnum); 6759 while (*p && (colnr_T)(p - line) < trypos->col) 6760 { 6761 if (cin_iscomment(p)) 6762 p = cin_skipcomment(p); 6763 else 6764 { 6765 p = skip_string(p); 6766 ++p; 6767 } 6768 } 6769 return (int)(p - line); 6770 } 6771 6772 /* 6773 * Find the '{' at the start of the block we are in. 6774 * Return NULL if no match found. 6775 * Ignore a '{' that is in a comment, makes indenting the next three lines 6776 * work. */ 6777 /* foo() */ 6778 /* { */ 6779 /* } */ 6780 6781 static pos_T * 6782 find_start_brace() /* XXX */ 6783 { 6784 pos_T cursor_save; 6785 pos_T *trypos; 6786 pos_T *pos; 6787 static pos_T pos_copy; 6788 6789 cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; 6790 while ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, '{', FM_BLOCKSTOP, 0)) != NULL) 6791 { 6792 pos_copy = *trypos; /* copy pos_T, next findmatch will change it */ 6793 trypos = &pos_copy; 6794 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 6795 pos = NULL; 6796 /* ignore the { if it's in a // or / * * / comment */ 6797 if ((colnr_T)cin_skip2pos(trypos) == trypos->col 6798 && (pos = ind_find_start_CORS()) == NULL) /* XXX */ 6799 break; 6800 if (pos != NULL) 6801 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; 6802 } 6803 curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; 6804 return trypos; 6805 } 6806 6807 /* 6808 * Find the matching '(', ignoring it if it is in a comment. 6809 * Return NULL if no match found. 6810 */ 6811 static pos_T * 6812 find_match_paren(ind_maxparen) /* XXX */ 6813 int ind_maxparen; 6814 { 6815 return find_match_char('(', ind_maxparen); 6816 } 6817 6818 static pos_T * 6819 find_match_char(c, ind_maxparen) /* XXX */ 6820 int c; 6821 int ind_maxparen; 6822 { 6823 pos_T cursor_save; 6824 pos_T *trypos; 6825 static pos_T pos_copy; 6826 int ind_maxp_wk; 6827 6828 cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; 6829 ind_maxp_wk = ind_maxparen; 6830 retry: 6831 if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, c, 0, ind_maxp_wk)) != NULL) 6832 { 6833 /* check if the ( is in a // comment */ 6834 if ((colnr_T)cin_skip2pos(trypos) > trypos->col) 6835 { 6836 ind_maxp_wk = ind_maxparen - (int)(cursor_save.lnum - trypos->lnum); 6837 if (ind_maxp_wk > 0) 6838 { 6839 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 6840 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; /* XXX */ 6841 goto retry; 6842 } 6843 trypos = NULL; 6844 } 6845 else 6846 { 6847 pos_T *trypos_wk; 6848 6849 pos_copy = *trypos; /* copy trypos, findmatch will change it */ 6850 trypos = &pos_copy; 6851 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 6852 if ((trypos_wk = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL) /* XXX */ 6853 { 6854 ind_maxp_wk = ind_maxparen - (int)(cursor_save.lnum 6855 - trypos_wk->lnum); 6856 if (ind_maxp_wk > 0) 6857 { 6858 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos_wk; 6859 goto retry; 6860 } 6861 trypos = NULL; 6862 } 6863 } 6864 } 6865 curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; 6866 return trypos; 6867 } 6868 6869 /* 6870 * Find the matching '(', ignoring it if it is in a comment or before an 6871 * unmatched {. 6872 * Return NULL if no match found. 6873 */ 6874 static pos_T * 6875 find_match_paren_after_brace(ind_maxparen) /* XXX */ 6876 int ind_maxparen; 6877 { 6878 pos_T *trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen); 6879 6880 if (trypos != NULL) 6881 { 6882 pos_T *tryposBrace = find_start_brace(); 6883 6884 /* If both an unmatched '(' and '{' is found. Ignore the '(' 6885 * position if the '{' is further down. */ 6886 if (tryposBrace != NULL 6887 && (trypos->lnum != tryposBrace->lnum 6888 ? trypos->lnum < tryposBrace->lnum 6889 : trypos->col < tryposBrace->col)) 6890 trypos = NULL; 6891 } 6892 return trypos; 6893 } 6894 6895 /* 6896 * Return ind_maxparen corrected for the difference in line number between the 6897 * cursor position and "startpos". This makes sure that searching for a 6898 * matching paren above the cursor line doesn't find a match because of 6899 * looking a few lines further. 6900 */ 6901 static int 6902 corr_ind_maxparen(startpos) 6903 pos_T *startpos; 6904 { 6905 long n = (long)startpos->lnum - (long)curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 6906 6907 if (n > 0 && n < curbuf->b_ind_maxparen / 2) 6908 return curbuf->b_ind_maxparen - (int)n; 6909 return curbuf->b_ind_maxparen; 6910 } 6911 6912 /* 6913 * Set w_cursor.col to the column number of the last unmatched ')' or '{' in 6914 * line "l". "l" must point to the start of the line. 6915 */ 6916 static int 6917 find_last_paren(l, start, end) 6918 char_u *l; 6919 int start, end; 6920 { 6921 int i; 6922 int retval = FALSE; 6923 int open_count = 0; 6924 6925 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; /* default is start of line */ 6926 6927 for (i = 0; l[i] != NUL; i++) 6928 { 6929 i = (int)(cin_skipcomment(l + i) - l); /* ignore parens in comments */ 6930 i = (int)(skip_string(l + i) - l); /* ignore parens in quotes */ 6931 if (l[i] == start) 6932 ++open_count; 6933 else if (l[i] == end) 6934 { 6935 if (open_count > 0) 6936 --open_count; 6937 else 6938 { 6939 curwin->w_cursor.col = i; 6940 retval = TRUE; 6941 } 6942 } 6943 } 6944 return retval; 6945 } 6946 6947 /* 6948 * Parse 'cinoptions' and set the values in "curbuf". 6949 * Must be called when 'cinoptions', 'shiftwidth' and/or 'tabstop' changes. 6950 */ 6951 void 6952 parse_cino(buf) 6953 buf_T *buf; 6954 { 6955 char_u *p; 6956 char_u *l; 6957 char_u *digits; 6958 int n; 6959 int divider; 6960 int fraction = 0; 6961 int sw = (int)get_sw_value(buf); 6962 6963 /* 6964 * Set the default values. 6965 */ 6966 /* Spaces from a block's opening brace the prevailing indent for that 6967 * block should be. */ 6968 buf->b_ind_level = sw; 6969 6970 /* Spaces from the edge of the line an open brace that's at the end of a 6971 * line is imagined to be. */ 6972 buf->b_ind_open_imag = 0; 6973 6974 /* Spaces from the prevailing indent for a line that is not preceded by 6975 * an opening brace. */ 6976 buf->b_ind_no_brace = 0; 6977 6978 /* Column where the first { of a function should be located }. */ 6979 buf->b_ind_first_open = 0; 6980 6981 /* Spaces from the prevailing indent a leftmost open brace should be 6982 * located. */ 6983 buf->b_ind_open_extra = 0; 6984 6985 /* Spaces from the matching open brace (real location for one at the left 6986 * edge; imaginary location from one that ends a line) the matching close 6987 * brace should be located. */ 6988 buf->b_ind_close_extra = 0; 6989 6990 /* Spaces from the edge of the line an open brace sitting in the leftmost 6991 * column is imagined to be. */ 6992 buf->b_ind_open_left_imag = 0; 6993 6994 /* Spaces jump labels should be shifted to the left if N is non-negative, 6995 * otherwise the jump label will be put to column 1. */ 6996 buf->b_ind_jump_label = -1; 6997 6998 /* Spaces from the switch() indent a "case xx" label should be located. */ 6999 buf->b_ind_case = sw; 7000 7001 /* Spaces from the "case xx:" code after a switch() should be located. */ 7002 buf->b_ind_case_code = sw; 7003 7004 /* Lineup break at end of case in switch() with case label. */ 7005 buf->b_ind_case_break = 0; 7006 7007 /* Spaces from the class declaration indent a scope declaration label 7008 * should be located. */ 7009 buf->b_ind_scopedecl = sw; 7010 7011 /* Spaces from the scope declaration label code should be located. */ 7012 buf->b_ind_scopedecl_code = sw; 7013 7014 /* Amount K&R-style parameters should be indented. */ 7015 buf->b_ind_param = sw; 7016 7017 /* Amount a function type spec should be indented. */ 7018 buf->b_ind_func_type = sw; 7019 7020 /* Amount a cpp base class declaration or constructor initialization 7021 * should be indented. */ 7022 buf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass = sw; 7023 7024 /* additional spaces beyond the prevailing indent a continuation line 7025 * should be located. */ 7026 buf->b_ind_continuation = sw; 7027 7028 /* Spaces from the indent of the line with an unclosed parentheses. */ 7029 buf->b_ind_unclosed = sw * 2; 7030 7031 /* Spaces from the indent of the line with an unclosed parentheses, which 7032 * itself is also unclosed. */ 7033 buf->b_ind_unclosed2 = sw; 7034 7035 /* Suppress ignoring spaces from the indent of a line starting with an 7036 * unclosed parentheses. */ 7037 buf->b_ind_unclosed_noignore = 0; 7038 7039 /* If the opening paren is the last nonwhite character on the line, and 7040 * b_ind_unclosed_wrapped is nonzero, use this indent relative to the outer 7041 * context (for very long lines). */ 7042 buf->b_ind_unclosed_wrapped = 0; 7043 7044 /* Suppress ignoring white space when lining up with the character after 7045 * an unclosed parentheses. */ 7046 buf->b_ind_unclosed_whiteok = 0; 7047 7048 /* Indent a closing parentheses under the line start of the matching 7049 * opening parentheses. */ 7050 buf->b_ind_matching_paren = 0; 7051 7052 /* Indent a closing parentheses under the previous line. */ 7053 buf->b_ind_paren_prev = 0; 7054 7055 /* Extra indent for comments. */ 7056 buf->b_ind_comment = 0; 7057 7058 /* Spaces from the comment opener when there is nothing after it. */ 7059 buf->b_ind_in_comment = 3; 7060 7061 /* Boolean: if non-zero, use b_ind_in_comment even if there is something 7062 * after the comment opener. */ 7063 buf->b_ind_in_comment2 = 0; 7064 7065 /* Max lines to search for an open paren. */ 7066 buf->b_ind_maxparen = 20; 7067 7068 /* Max lines to search for an open comment. */ 7069 buf->b_ind_maxcomment = 70; 7070 7071 /* Handle braces for java code. */ 7072 buf->b_ind_java = 0; 7073 7074 /* Not to confuse JS object properties with labels. */ 7075 buf->b_ind_js = 0; 7076 7077 /* Handle blocked cases correctly. */ 7078 buf->b_ind_keep_case_label = 0; 7079 7080 /* Handle C++ namespace. */ 7081 buf->b_ind_cpp_namespace = 0; 7082 7083 /* Handle continuation lines containing conditions of if(), for() and 7084 * while(). */ 7085 buf->b_ind_if_for_while = 0; 7086 7087 for (p = buf->b_p_cino; *p; ) 7088 { 7089 l = p++; 7090 if (*p == '-') 7091 ++p; 7092 digits = p; /* remember where the digits start */ 7093 n = getdigits(&p); 7094 divider = 0; 7095 if (*p == '.') /* ".5s" means a fraction */ 7096 { 7097 fraction = atol((char *)++p); 7098 while (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p)) 7099 { 7100 ++p; 7101 if (divider) 7102 divider *= 10; 7103 else 7104 divider = 10; 7105 } 7106 } 7107 if (*p == 's') /* "2s" means two times 'shiftwidth' */ 7108 { 7109 if (p == digits) 7110 n = sw; /* just "s" is one 'shiftwidth' */ 7111 else 7112 { 7113 n *= sw; 7114 if (divider) 7115 n += (sw * fraction + divider / 2) / divider; 7116 } 7117 ++p; 7118 } 7119 if (l[1] == '-') 7120 n = -n; 7121 7122 /* When adding an entry here, also update the default 'cinoptions' in 7123 * doc/indent.txt, and add explanation for it! */ 7124 switch (*l) 7125 { 7126 case '>': buf->b_ind_level = n; break; 7127 case 'e': buf->b_ind_open_imag = n; break; 7128 case 'n': buf->b_ind_no_brace = n; break; 7129 case 'f': buf->b_ind_first_open = n; break; 7130 case '{': buf->b_ind_open_extra = n; break; 7131 case '}': buf->b_ind_close_extra = n; break; 7132 case '^': buf->b_ind_open_left_imag = n; break; 7133 case 'L': buf->b_ind_jump_label = n; break; 7134 case ':': buf->b_ind_case = n; break; 7135 case '=': buf->b_ind_case_code = n; break; 7136 case 'b': buf->b_ind_case_break = n; break; 7137 case 'p': buf->b_ind_param = n; break; 7138 case 't': buf->b_ind_func_type = n; break; 7139 case '/': buf->b_ind_comment = n; break; 7140 case 'c': buf->b_ind_in_comment = n; break; 7141 case 'C': buf->b_ind_in_comment2 = n; break; 7142 case 'i': buf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass = n; break; 7143 case '+': buf->b_ind_continuation = n; break; 7144 case '(': buf->b_ind_unclosed = n; break; 7145 case 'u': buf->b_ind_unclosed2 = n; break; 7146 case 'U': buf->b_ind_unclosed_noignore = n; break; 7147 case 'W': buf->b_ind_unclosed_wrapped = n; break; 7148 case 'w': buf->b_ind_unclosed_whiteok = n; break; 7149 case 'm': buf->b_ind_matching_paren = n; break; 7150 case 'M': buf->b_ind_paren_prev = n; break; 7151 case ')': buf->b_ind_maxparen = n; break; 7152 case '*': buf->b_ind_maxcomment = n; break; 7153 case 'g': buf->b_ind_scopedecl = n; break; 7154 case 'h': buf->b_ind_scopedecl_code = n; break; 7155 case 'j': buf->b_ind_java = n; break; 7156 case 'J': buf->b_ind_js = n; break; 7157 case 'l': buf->b_ind_keep_case_label = n; break; 7158 case '#': buf->b_ind_hash_comment = n; break; 7159 case 'N': buf->b_ind_cpp_namespace = n; break; 7160 case 'k': buf->b_ind_if_for_while = n; break; 7161 } 7162 if (*p == ',') 7163 ++p; 7164 } 7165 } 7166 7167 /* 7168 * Return the desired indent for C code. 7169 * Return -1 if the indent should be left alone (inside a raw string). 7170 */ 7171 int 7172 get_c_indent() 7173 { 7174 pos_T cur_curpos; 7175 int amount; 7176 int scope_amount; 7177 int cur_amount = MAXCOL; 7178 colnr_T col; 7179 char_u *theline; 7180 char_u *linecopy; 7181 pos_T *trypos; 7182 pos_T *comment_pos; 7183 pos_T *tryposBrace = NULL; 7184 pos_T tryposCopy; 7185 pos_T our_paren_pos; 7186 char_u *start; 7187 int start_brace; 7188 #define BRACE_IN_COL0 1 /* '{' is in column 0 */ 7189 #define BRACE_AT_START 2 /* '{' is at start of line */ 7190 #define BRACE_AT_END 3 /* '{' is at end of line */ 7191 linenr_T ourscope; 7192 char_u *l; 7193 char_u *look; 7194 char_u terminated; 7195 int lookfor; 7196 #define LOOKFOR_INITIAL 0 7197 #define LOOKFOR_IF 1 7198 #define LOOKFOR_DO 2 7199 #define LOOKFOR_CASE 3 7200 #define LOOKFOR_ANY 4 7201 #define LOOKFOR_TERM 5 7202 #define LOOKFOR_UNTERM 6 7203 #define LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL 7 7204 #define LOOKFOR_NOBREAK 8 7205 #define LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS 9 7206 #define LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT 10 7207 #define LOOKFOR_JS_KEY 11 7208 #define LOOKFOR_COMMA 12 7209 7210 int whilelevel; 7211 linenr_T lnum; 7212 int n; 7213 int iscase; 7214 int lookfor_break; 7215 int lookfor_cpp_namespace = FALSE; 7216 int cont_amount = 0; /* amount for continuation line */ 7217 int original_line_islabel; 7218 int added_to_amount = 0; 7219 int js_cur_has_key = 0; 7220 cpp_baseclass_cache_T cache_cpp_baseclass = { FALSE, { MAXLNUM, 0 } }; 7221 7222 /* make a copy, value is changed below */ 7223 int ind_continuation = curbuf->b_ind_continuation; 7224 7225 /* remember where the cursor was when we started */ 7226 cur_curpos = curwin->w_cursor; 7227 7228 /* if we are at line 1 zero indent is fine, right? */ 7229 if (cur_curpos.lnum == 1) 7230 return 0; 7231 7232 /* Get a copy of the current contents of the line. 7233 * This is required, because only the most recent line obtained with 7234 * ml_get is valid! */ 7235 linecopy = vim_strsave(ml_get(cur_curpos.lnum)); 7236 if (linecopy == NULL) 7237 return 0; 7238 7239 /* 7240 * In insert mode and the cursor is on a ')' truncate the line at the 7241 * cursor position. We don't want to line up with the matching '(' when 7242 * inserting new stuff. 7243 * For unknown reasons the cursor might be past the end of the line, thus 7244 * check for that. 7245 */ 7246 if ((State & INSERT) 7247 && curwin->w_cursor.col < (colnr_T)STRLEN(linecopy) 7248 && linecopy[curwin->w_cursor.col] == ')') 7249 linecopy[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL; 7250 7251 theline = skipwhite(linecopy); 7252 7253 /* move the cursor to the start of the line */ 7254 7255 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 7256 7257 original_line_islabel = cin_islabel(); /* XXX */ 7258 7259 /* 7260 * If we are inside a raw string don't change the indent. 7261 * Ignore a raw string inside a comment. 7262 */ 7263 comment_pos = ind_find_start_comment(); 7264 if (comment_pos != NULL) 7265 { 7266 /* findmatchlimit() static pos is overwritten, make a copy */ 7267 tryposCopy = *comment_pos; 7268 comment_pos = &tryposCopy; 7269 } 7270 trypos = find_start_rawstring(curbuf->b_ind_maxcomment); 7271 if (trypos != NULL && (comment_pos == NULL || lt(*trypos, *comment_pos))) 7272 { 7273 amount = -1; 7274 goto laterend; 7275 } 7276 7277 /* 7278 * #defines and so on always go at the left when included in 'cinkeys'. 7279 */ 7280 if (*theline == '#' && (*linecopy == '#' || in_cinkeys('#', ' ', TRUE))) 7281 { 7282 amount = curbuf->b_ind_hash_comment; 7283 goto theend; 7284 } 7285 7286 /* 7287 * Is it a non-case label? Then that goes at the left margin too unless: 7288 * - JS flag is set. 7289 * - 'L' item has a positive value. 7290 */ 7291 if (original_line_islabel && !curbuf->b_ind_js 7292 && curbuf->b_ind_jump_label < 0) 7293 { 7294 amount = 0; 7295 goto theend; 7296 } 7297 7298 /* 7299 * If we're inside a "//" comment and there is a "//" comment in a 7300 * previous line, lineup with that one. 7301 */ 7302 if (cin_islinecomment(theline) 7303 && (trypos = find_line_comment()) != NULL) /* XXX */ 7304 { 7305 /* find how indented the line beginning the comment is */ 7306 getvcol(curwin, trypos, &col, NULL, NULL); 7307 amount = col; 7308 goto theend; 7309 } 7310 7311 /* 7312 * If we're inside a comment and not looking at the start of the 7313 * comment, try using the 'comments' option. 7314 */ 7315 if (!cin_iscomment(theline) && comment_pos != NULL) /* XXX */ 7316 { 7317 int lead_start_len = 2; 7318 int lead_middle_len = 1; 7319 char_u lead_start[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* start-comment string */ 7320 char_u lead_middle[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* middle-comment string */ 7321 char_u lead_end[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* end-comment string */ 7322 char_u *p; 7323 int start_align = 0; 7324 int start_off = 0; 7325 int done = FALSE; 7326 7327 /* find how indented the line beginning the comment is */ 7328 getvcol(curwin, comment_pos, &col, NULL, NULL); 7329 amount = col; 7330 *lead_start = NUL; 7331 *lead_middle = NUL; 7332 7333 p = curbuf->b_p_com; 7334 while (*p != NUL) 7335 { 7336 int align = 0; 7337 int off = 0; 7338 int what = 0; 7339 7340 while (*p != NUL && *p != ':') 7341 { 7342 if (*p == COM_START || *p == COM_END || *p == COM_MIDDLE) 7343 what = *p++; 7344 else if (*p == COM_LEFT || *p == COM_RIGHT) 7345 align = *p++; 7346 else if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p) || *p == '-') 7347 off = getdigits(&p); 7348 else 7349 ++p; 7350 } 7351 7352 if (*p == ':') 7353 ++p; 7354 (void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_end, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); 7355 if (what == COM_START) 7356 { 7357 STRCPY(lead_start, lead_end); 7358 lead_start_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_start); 7359 start_off = off; 7360 start_align = align; 7361 } 7362 else if (what == COM_MIDDLE) 7363 { 7364 STRCPY(lead_middle, lead_end); 7365 lead_middle_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_middle); 7366 } 7367 else if (what == COM_END) 7368 { 7369 /* If our line starts with the middle comment string, line it 7370 * up with the comment opener per the 'comments' option. */ 7371 if (STRNCMP(theline, lead_middle, lead_middle_len) == 0 7372 && STRNCMP(theline, lead_end, STRLEN(lead_end)) != 0) 7373 { 7374 done = TRUE; 7375 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) 7376 { 7377 /* If the start comment string matches in the previous 7378 * line, use the indent of that line plus offset. If 7379 * the middle comment string matches in the previous 7380 * line, use the indent of that line. XXX */ 7381 look = skipwhite(ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1)); 7382 if (STRNCMP(look, lead_start, lead_start_len) == 0) 7383 amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); 7384 else if (STRNCMP(look, lead_middle, 7385 lead_middle_len) == 0) 7386 { 7387 amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); 7388 break; 7389 } 7390 /* If the start comment string doesn't match with the 7391 * start of the comment, skip this entry. XXX */ 7392 else if (STRNCMP(ml_get(comment_pos->lnum) + comment_pos->col, 7393 lead_start, lead_start_len) != 0) 7394 continue; 7395 } 7396 if (start_off != 0) 7397 amount += start_off; 7398 else if (start_align == COM_RIGHT) 7399 amount += vim_strsize(lead_start) 7400 - vim_strsize(lead_middle); 7401 break; 7402 } 7403 7404 /* If our line starts with the end comment string, line it up 7405 * with the middle comment */ 7406 if (STRNCMP(theline, lead_middle, lead_middle_len) != 0 7407 && STRNCMP(theline, lead_end, STRLEN(lead_end)) == 0) 7408 { 7409 amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); 7410 /* XXX */ 7411 if (off != 0) 7412 amount += off; 7413 else if (align == COM_RIGHT) 7414 amount += vim_strsize(lead_start) 7415 - vim_strsize(lead_middle); 7416 done = TRUE; 7417 break; 7418 } 7419 } 7420 } 7421 7422 /* If our line starts with an asterisk, line up with the 7423 * asterisk in the comment opener; otherwise, line up 7424 * with the first character of the comment text. 7425 */ 7426 if (done) 7427 ; 7428 else if (theline[0] == '*') 7429 amount += 1; 7430 else 7431 { 7432 /* 7433 * If we are more than one line away from the comment opener, take 7434 * the indent of the previous non-empty line. If 'cino' has "CO" 7435 * and we are just below the comment opener and there are any 7436 * white characters after it line up with the text after it; 7437 * otherwise, add the amount specified by "c" in 'cino' 7438 */ 7439 amount = -1; 7440 for (lnum = cur_curpos.lnum - 1; lnum > comment_pos->lnum; --lnum) 7441 { 7442 if (linewhite(lnum)) /* skip blank lines */ 7443 continue; 7444 amount = get_indent_lnum(lnum); /* XXX */ 7445 break; 7446 } 7447 if (amount == -1) /* use the comment opener */ 7448 { 7449 if (!curbuf->b_ind_in_comment2) 7450 { 7451 start = ml_get(comment_pos->lnum); 7452 look = start + comment_pos->col + 2; /* skip / and * */ 7453 if (*look != NUL) /* if something after it */ 7454 comment_pos->col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(look) - start); 7455 } 7456 getvcol(curwin, comment_pos, &col, NULL, NULL); 7457 amount = col; 7458 if (curbuf->b_ind_in_comment2 || *look == NUL) 7459 amount += curbuf->b_ind_in_comment; 7460 } 7461 } 7462 goto theend; 7463 } 7464 7465 /* 7466 * Are we looking at a ']' that has a match? 7467 */ 7468 if (*skipwhite(theline) == ']' 7469 && (trypos = find_match_char('[', curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL) 7470 { 7471 /* align with the line containing the '['. */ 7472 amount = get_indent_lnum(trypos->lnum); 7473 goto theend; 7474 } 7475 7476 /* 7477 * Are we inside parentheses or braces? 7478 */ /* XXX */ 7479 if (((trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL 7480 && curbuf->b_ind_java == 0) 7481 || (tryposBrace = find_start_brace()) != NULL 7482 || trypos != NULL) 7483 { 7484 if (trypos != NULL && tryposBrace != NULL) 7485 { 7486 /* Both an unmatched '(' and '{' is found. Use the one which is 7487 * closer to the current cursor position, set the other to NULL. */ 7488 if (trypos->lnum != tryposBrace->lnum 7489 ? trypos->lnum < tryposBrace->lnum 7490 : trypos->col < tryposBrace->col) 7491 trypos = NULL; 7492 else 7493 tryposBrace = NULL; 7494 } 7495 7496 if (trypos != NULL) 7497 { 7498 /* 7499 * If the matching paren is more than one line away, use the indent of 7500 * a previous non-empty line that matches the same paren. 7501 */ 7502 if (theline[0] == ')' && curbuf->b_ind_paren_prev) 7503 { 7504 /* Line up with the start of the matching paren line. */ 7505 amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); /* XXX */ 7506 } 7507 else 7508 { 7509 amount = -1; 7510 our_paren_pos = *trypos; 7511 for (lnum = cur_curpos.lnum - 1; lnum > our_paren_pos.lnum; --lnum) 7512 { 7513 l = skipwhite(ml_get(lnum)); 7514 if (cin_nocode(l)) /* skip comment lines */ 7515 continue; 7516 if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &lnum)) 7517 continue; /* ignore #define, #if, etc. */ 7518 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum; 7519 7520 /* Skip a comment or raw string. XXX */ 7521 if ((trypos = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL) 7522 { 7523 lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; 7524 continue; 7525 } 7526 7527 /* XXX */ 7528 if ((trypos = find_match_paren( 7529 corr_ind_maxparen(&cur_curpos))) != NULL 7530 && trypos->lnum == our_paren_pos.lnum 7531 && trypos->col == our_paren_pos.col) 7532 { 7533 amount = get_indent_lnum(lnum); /* XXX */ 7534 7535 if (theline[0] == ')') 7536 { 7537 if (our_paren_pos.lnum != lnum 7538 && cur_amount > amount) 7539 cur_amount = amount; 7540 amount = -1; 7541 } 7542 break; 7543 } 7544 } 7545 } 7546 7547 /* 7548 * Line up with line where the matching paren is. XXX 7549 * If the line starts with a '(' or the indent for unclosed 7550 * parentheses is zero, line up with the unclosed parentheses. 7551 */ 7552 if (amount == -1) 7553 { 7554 int ignore_paren_col = 0; 7555 int is_if_for_while = 0; 7556 7557 if (curbuf->b_ind_if_for_while) 7558 { 7559 /* Look for the outermost opening parenthesis on this line 7560 * and check whether it belongs to an "if", "for" or "while". */ 7561 7562 pos_T cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; 7563 pos_T outermost; 7564 char_u *line; 7565 7566 trypos = &our_paren_pos; 7567 do { 7568 outermost = *trypos; 7569 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = outermost.lnum; 7570 curwin->w_cursor.col = outermost.col; 7571 7572 trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen); 7573 } while (trypos && trypos->lnum == outermost.lnum); 7574 7575 curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; 7576 7577 line = ml_get(outermost.lnum); 7578 7579 is_if_for_while = 7580 cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset(line, &outermost.col); 7581 } 7582 7583 amount = skip_label(our_paren_pos.lnum, &look); 7584 look = skipwhite(look); 7585 if (*look == '(') 7586 { 7587 linenr_T save_lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 7588 char_u *line; 7589 int look_col; 7590 7591 /* Ignore a '(' in front of the line that has a match before 7592 * our matching '('. */ 7593 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = our_paren_pos.lnum; 7594 line = ml_get_curline(); 7595 look_col = (int)(look - line); 7596 curwin->w_cursor.col = look_col + 1; 7597 if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, ')', 0, 7598 curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) 7599 != NULL 7600 && trypos->lnum == our_paren_pos.lnum 7601 && trypos->col < our_paren_pos.col) 7602 ignore_paren_col = trypos->col + 1; 7603 7604 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = save_lnum; 7605 look = ml_get(our_paren_pos.lnum) + look_col; 7606 } 7607 if (theline[0] == ')' || (curbuf->b_ind_unclosed == 0 7608 && is_if_for_while == 0) 7609 || (!curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_noignore && *look == '(' 7610 && ignore_paren_col == 0)) 7611 { 7612 /* 7613 * If we're looking at a close paren, line up right there; 7614 * otherwise, line up with the next (non-white) character. 7615 * When b_ind_unclosed_wrapped is set and the matching paren is 7616 * the last nonwhite character of the line, use either the 7617 * indent of the current line or the indentation of the next 7618 * outer paren and add b_ind_unclosed_wrapped (for very long 7619 * lines). 7620 */ 7621 if (theline[0] != ')') 7622 { 7623 cur_amount = MAXCOL; 7624 l = ml_get(our_paren_pos.lnum); 7625 if (curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_wrapped 7626 && cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)"(", NULL)) 7627 { 7628 /* look for opening unmatched paren, indent one level 7629 * for each additional level */ 7630 n = 1; 7631 for (col = 0; col < our_paren_pos.col; ++col) 7632 { 7633 switch (l[col]) 7634 { 7635 case '(': 7636 case '{': ++n; 7637 break; 7638 7639 case ')': 7640 case '}': if (n > 1) 7641 --n; 7642 break; 7643 } 7644 } 7645 7646 our_paren_pos.col = 0; 7647 amount += n * curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_wrapped; 7648 } 7649 else if (curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_whiteok) 7650 our_paren_pos.col++; 7651 else 7652 { 7653 col = our_paren_pos.col + 1; 7654 while (vim_iswhite(l[col])) 7655 col++; 7656 if (l[col] != NUL) /* In case of trailing space */ 7657 our_paren_pos.col = col; 7658 else 7659 our_paren_pos.col++; 7660 } 7661 } 7662 7663 /* 7664 * Find how indented the paren is, or the character after it 7665 * if we did the above "if". 7666 */ 7667 if (our_paren_pos.col > 0) 7668 { 7669 getvcol(curwin, &our_paren_pos, &col, NULL, NULL); 7670 if (cur_amount > (int)col) 7671 cur_amount = col; 7672 } 7673 } 7674 7675 if (theline[0] == ')' && curbuf->b_ind_matching_paren) 7676 { 7677 /* Line up with the start of the matching paren line. */ 7678 } 7679 else if ((curbuf->b_ind_unclosed == 0 && is_if_for_while == 0) 7680 || (!curbuf->b_ind_unclosed_noignore 7681 && *look == '(' && ignore_paren_col == 0)) 7682 { 7683 if (cur_amount != MAXCOL) 7684 amount = cur_amount; 7685 } 7686 else 7687 { 7688 /* Add b_ind_unclosed2 for each '(' before our matching one, 7689 * but ignore (void) before the line (ignore_paren_col). */ 7690 col = our_paren_pos.col; 7691 while ((int)our_paren_pos.col > ignore_paren_col) 7692 { 7693 --our_paren_pos.col; 7694 switch (*ml_get_pos(&our_paren_pos)) 7695 { 7696 case '(': amount += curbuf->b_ind_unclosed2; 7697 col = our_paren_pos.col; 7698 break; 7699 case ')': amount -= curbuf->b_ind_unclosed2; 7700 col = MAXCOL; 7701 break; 7702 } 7703 } 7704 7705 /* Use b_ind_unclosed once, when the first '(' is not inside 7706 * braces */ 7707 if (col == MAXCOL) 7708 amount += curbuf->b_ind_unclosed; 7709 else 7710 { 7711 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = our_paren_pos.lnum; 7712 curwin->w_cursor.col = col; 7713 if (find_match_paren_after_brace(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen) 7714 != NULL) 7715 amount += curbuf->b_ind_unclosed2; 7716 else 7717 { 7718 if (is_if_for_while) 7719 amount += curbuf->b_ind_if_for_while; 7720 else 7721 amount += curbuf->b_ind_unclosed; 7722 } 7723 } 7724 /* 7725 * For a line starting with ')' use the minimum of the two 7726 * positions, to avoid giving it more indent than the previous 7727 * lines: 7728 * func_long_name( if (x 7729 * arg && yy 7730 * ) ^ not here ) ^ not here 7731 */ 7732 if (cur_amount < amount) 7733 amount = cur_amount; 7734 } 7735 } 7736 7737 /* add extra indent for a comment */ 7738 if (cin_iscomment(theline)) 7739 amount += curbuf->b_ind_comment; 7740 } 7741 else 7742 { 7743 /* 7744 * We are inside braces, there is a { before this line at the position 7745 * stored in tryposBrace. 7746 * Make a copy of tryposBrace, it may point to pos_copy inside 7747 * find_start_brace(), which may be changed somewhere. 7748 */ 7749 tryposCopy = *tryposBrace; 7750 tryposBrace = &tryposCopy; 7751 trypos = tryposBrace; 7752 ourscope = trypos->lnum; 7753 start = ml_get(ourscope); 7754 7755 /* 7756 * Now figure out how indented the line is in general. 7757 * If the brace was at the start of the line, we use that; 7758 * otherwise, check out the indentation of the line as 7759 * a whole and then add the "imaginary indent" to that. 7760 */ 7761 look = skipwhite(start); 7762 if (*look == '{') 7763 { 7764 getvcol(curwin, trypos, &col, NULL, NULL); 7765 amount = col; 7766 if (*start == '{') 7767 start_brace = BRACE_IN_COL0; 7768 else 7769 start_brace = BRACE_AT_START; 7770 } 7771 else 7772 { 7773 /* That opening brace might have been on a continuation 7774 * line. if so, find the start of the line. */ 7775 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = ourscope; 7776 7777 /* Position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that 7778 * matching it will take us back to the start of the line. */ 7779 lnum = ourscope; 7780 if (find_last_paren(start, '(', ')') 7781 && (trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) 7782 != NULL) 7783 lnum = trypos->lnum; 7784 7785 /* It could have been something like 7786 * case 1: if (asdf && 7787 * ldfd) { 7788 * } 7789 */ 7790 if ((curbuf->b_ind_js || curbuf->b_ind_keep_case_label) 7791 && cin_iscase(skipwhite(ml_get_curline()), FALSE)) 7792 amount = get_indent(); 7793 else if (curbuf->b_ind_js) 7794 amount = get_indent_lnum(lnum); 7795 else 7796 amount = skip_label(lnum, &l); 7797 7798 start_brace = BRACE_AT_END; 7799 } 7800 7801 /* For Javascript check if the line starts with "key:". */ 7802 if (curbuf->b_ind_js) 7803 js_cur_has_key = cin_has_js_key(theline); 7804 7805 /* 7806 * If we're looking at a closing brace, that's where 7807 * we want to be. otherwise, add the amount of room 7808 * that an indent is supposed to be. 7809 */ 7810 if (theline[0] == '}') 7811 { 7812 /* 7813 * they may want closing braces to line up with something 7814 * other than the open brace. indulge them, if so. 7815 */ 7816 amount += curbuf->b_ind_close_extra; 7817 } 7818 else 7819 { 7820 /* 7821 * If we're looking at an "else", try to find an "if" 7822 * to match it with. 7823 * If we're looking at a "while", try to find a "do" 7824 * to match it with. 7825 */ 7826 lookfor = LOOKFOR_INITIAL; 7827 if (cin_iselse(theline)) 7828 lookfor = LOOKFOR_IF; 7829 else if (cin_iswhileofdo(theline, cur_curpos.lnum)) /* XXX */ 7830 lookfor = LOOKFOR_DO; 7831 if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_INITIAL) 7832 { 7833 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = cur_curpos.lnum; 7834 if (find_match(lookfor, ourscope) == OK) 7835 { 7836 amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ 7837 goto theend; 7838 } 7839 } 7840 7841 /* 7842 * We get here if we are not on an "while-of-do" or "else" (or 7843 * failed to find a matching "if"). 7844 * Search backwards for something to line up with. 7845 * First set amount for when we don't find anything. 7846 */ 7847 7848 /* 7849 * if the '{' is _really_ at the left margin, use the imaginary 7850 * location of a left-margin brace. Otherwise, correct the 7851 * location for b_ind_open_extra. 7852 */ 7853 7854 if (start_brace == BRACE_IN_COL0) /* '{' is in column 0 */ 7855 { 7856 amount = curbuf->b_ind_open_left_imag; 7857 lookfor_cpp_namespace = TRUE; 7858 } 7859 else if (start_brace == BRACE_AT_START && 7860 lookfor_cpp_namespace) /* '{' is at start */ 7861 { 7862 7863 lookfor_cpp_namespace = TRUE; 7864 } 7865 else 7866 { 7867 if (start_brace == BRACE_AT_END) /* '{' is at end of line */ 7868 { 7869 amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_imag; 7870 7871 l = skipwhite(ml_get_curline()); 7872 if (cin_is_cpp_namespace(l)) 7873 amount += curbuf->b_ind_cpp_namespace; 7874 } 7875 else 7876 { 7877 /* Compensate for adding b_ind_open_extra later. */ 7878 amount -= curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 7879 if (amount < 0) 7880 amount = 0; 7881 } 7882 } 7883 7884 lookfor_break = FALSE; 7885 7886 if (cin_iscase(theline, FALSE)) /* it's a switch() label */ 7887 { 7888 lookfor = LOOKFOR_CASE; /* find a previous switch() label */ 7889 amount += curbuf->b_ind_case; 7890 } 7891 else if (cin_isscopedecl(theline)) /* private:, ... */ 7892 { 7893 lookfor = LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL; /* class decl is this block */ 7894 amount += curbuf->b_ind_scopedecl; 7895 } 7896 else 7897 { 7898 if (curbuf->b_ind_case_break && cin_isbreak(theline)) 7899 /* break; ... */ 7900 lookfor_break = TRUE; 7901 7902 lookfor = LOOKFOR_INITIAL; 7903 /* b_ind_level from start of block */ 7904 amount += curbuf->b_ind_level; 7905 } 7906 scope_amount = amount; 7907 whilelevel = 0; 7908 7909 /* 7910 * Search backwards. If we find something we recognize, line up 7911 * with that. 7912 * 7913 * If we're looking at an open brace, indent 7914 * the usual amount relative to the conditional 7915 * that opens the block. 7916 */ 7917 curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos; 7918 for (;;) 7919 { 7920 curwin->w_cursor.lnum--; 7921 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 7922 7923 /* 7924 * If we went all the way back to the start of our scope, line 7925 * up with it. 7926 */ 7927 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum <= ourscope) 7928 { 7929 /* we reached end of scope: 7930 * if looking for a enum or structure initialization 7931 * go further back: 7932 * if it is an initializer (enum xxx or xxx =), then 7933 * don't add ind_continuation, otherwise it is a variable 7934 * declaration: 7935 * int x, 7936 * here; <-- add ind_continuation 7937 */ 7938 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) 7939 { 7940 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == 0 7941 || curwin->w_cursor.lnum 7942 < ourscope - curbuf->b_ind_maxparen) 7943 { 7944 /* nothing found (abuse curbuf->b_ind_maxparen as 7945 * limit) assume terminated line (i.e. a variable 7946 * initialization) */ 7947 if (cont_amount > 0) 7948 amount = cont_amount; 7949 else if (!curbuf->b_ind_js) 7950 amount += ind_continuation; 7951 break; 7952 } 7953 7954 l = ml_get_curline(); 7955 7956 /* 7957 * If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip to 7958 * the start of it. 7959 */ 7960 trypos = ind_find_start_CORS(); 7961 if (trypos != NULL) 7962 { 7963 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; 7964 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 7965 continue; 7966 } 7967 7968 /* 7969 * Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines. 7970 */ 7971 if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) 7972 continue; 7973 7974 if (cin_nocode(l)) 7975 continue; 7976 7977 terminated = cin_isterminated(l, FALSE, TRUE); 7978 7979 /* 7980 * If we are at top level and the line looks like a 7981 * function declaration, we are done 7982 * (it's a variable declaration). 7983 */ 7984 if (start_brace != BRACE_IN_COL0 7985 || !cin_isfuncdecl(&l, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0)) 7986 { 7987 /* if the line is terminated with another ',' 7988 * it is a continued variable initialization. 7989 * don't add extra indent. 7990 * TODO: does not work, if a function 7991 * declaration is split over multiple lines: 7992 * cin_isfuncdecl returns FALSE then. 7993 */ 7994 if (terminated == ',') 7995 break; 7996 7997 /* if it es a enum declaration or an assignment, 7998 * we are done. 7999 */ 8000 if (terminated != ';' && cin_isinit()) 8001 break; 8002 8003 /* nothing useful found */ 8004 if (terminated == 0 || terminated == '{') 8005 continue; 8006 } 8007 8008 if (terminated != ';') 8009 { 8010 /* Skip parens and braces. Position the cursor 8011 * over the rightmost paren, so that matching it 8012 * will take us back to the start of the line. 8013 */ /* XXX */ 8014 trypos = NULL; 8015 if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')')) 8016 trypos = find_match_paren( 8017 curbuf->b_ind_maxparen); 8018 8019 if (trypos == NULL && find_last_paren(l, '{', '}')) 8020 trypos = find_start_brace(); 8021 8022 if (trypos != NULL) 8023 { 8024 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; 8025 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8026 continue; 8027 } 8028 } 8029 8030 /* it's a variable declaration, add indentation 8031 * like in 8032 * int a, 8033 * b; 8034 */ 8035 if (cont_amount > 0) 8036 amount = cont_amount; 8037 else 8038 amount += ind_continuation; 8039 } 8040 else if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM) 8041 { 8042 if (cont_amount > 0) 8043 amount = cont_amount; 8044 else 8045 amount += ind_continuation; 8046 } 8047 else 8048 { 8049 if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM 8050 && lookfor != LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS 8051 && lookfor != LOOKFOR_COMMA) 8052 { 8053 amount = scope_amount; 8054 if (theline[0] == '{') 8055 { 8056 amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 8057 added_to_amount = curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 8058 } 8059 } 8060 8061 if (lookfor_cpp_namespace) 8062 { 8063 /* 8064 * Looking for C++ namespace, need to look further 8065 * back. 8066 */ 8067 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == ourscope) 8068 continue; 8069 8070 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == 0 8071 || curwin->w_cursor.lnum 8072 < ourscope - FIND_NAMESPACE_LIM) 8073 break; 8074 8075 l = ml_get_curline(); 8076 8077 /* If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip 8078 * to the start of it. */ 8079 trypos = ind_find_start_CORS(); 8080 if (trypos != NULL) 8081 { 8082 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; 8083 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8084 continue; 8085 } 8086 8087 /* Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines. */ 8088 if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) 8089 continue; 8090 8091 /* Finally the actual check for "namespace". */ 8092 if (cin_is_cpp_namespace(l)) 8093 { 8094 amount += curbuf->b_ind_cpp_namespace 8095 - added_to_amount; 8096 break; 8097 } 8098 8099 if (cin_nocode(l)) 8100 continue; 8101 } 8102 } 8103 break; 8104 } 8105 8106 /* 8107 * If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip to the start 8108 * of it. 8109 */ /* XXX */ 8110 if ((trypos = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL) 8111 { 8112 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; 8113 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8114 continue; 8115 } 8116 8117 l = ml_get_curline(); 8118 8119 /* 8120 * If this is a switch() label, may line up relative to that. 8121 * If this is a C++ scope declaration, do the same. 8122 */ 8123 iscase = cin_iscase(l, FALSE); 8124 if (iscase || cin_isscopedecl(l)) 8125 { 8126 /* we are only looking for cpp base class 8127 * declaration/initialization any longer */ 8128 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS) 8129 break; 8130 8131 /* When looking for a "do" we are not interested in 8132 * labels. */ 8133 if (whilelevel > 0) 8134 continue; 8135 8136 /* 8137 * case xx: 8138 * c = 99 + <- this indent plus continuation 8139 *-> here; 8140 */ 8141 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM 8142 || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) 8143 { 8144 if (cont_amount > 0) 8145 amount = cont_amount; 8146 else 8147 amount += ind_continuation; 8148 break; 8149 } 8150 8151 /* 8152 * case xx: <- line up with this case 8153 * x = 333; 8154 * case yy: 8155 */ 8156 if ( (iscase && lookfor == LOOKFOR_CASE) 8157 || (iscase && lookfor_break) 8158 || (!iscase && lookfor == LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL)) 8159 { 8160 /* 8161 * Check that this case label is not for another 8162 * switch() 8163 */ /* XXX */ 8164 if ((trypos = find_start_brace()) == NULL 8165 || trypos->lnum == ourscope) 8166 { 8167 amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ 8168 break; 8169 } 8170 continue; 8171 } 8172 8173 n = get_indent_nolabel(curwin->w_cursor.lnum); /* XXX */ 8174 8175 /* 8176 * case xx: if (cond) <- line up with this if 8177 * y = y + 1; 8178 * -> s = 99; 8179 * 8180 * case xx: 8181 * if (cond) <- line up with this line 8182 * y = y + 1; 8183 * -> s = 99; 8184 */ 8185 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM) 8186 { 8187 if (n) 8188 amount = n; 8189 8190 if (!lookfor_break) 8191 break; 8192 } 8193 8194 /* 8195 * case xx: x = x + 1; <- line up with this x 8196 * -> y = y + 1; 8197 * 8198 * case xx: if (cond) <- line up with this if 8199 * -> y = y + 1; 8200 */ 8201 if (n) 8202 { 8203 amount = n; 8204 l = after_label(ml_get_curline()); 8205 if (l != NULL && cin_is_cinword(l)) 8206 { 8207 if (theline[0] == '{') 8208 amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 8209 else 8210 amount += curbuf->b_ind_level 8211 + curbuf->b_ind_no_brace; 8212 } 8213 break; 8214 } 8215 8216 /* 8217 * Try to get the indent of a statement before the switch 8218 * label. If nothing is found, line up relative to the 8219 * switch label. 8220 * break; <- may line up with this line 8221 * case xx: 8222 * -> y = 1; 8223 */ 8224 scope_amount = get_indent() + (iscase /* XXX */ 8225 ? curbuf->b_ind_case_code 8226 : curbuf->b_ind_scopedecl_code); 8227 lookfor = curbuf->b_ind_case_break 8228 ? LOOKFOR_NOBREAK : LOOKFOR_ANY; 8229 continue; 8230 } 8231 8232 /* 8233 * Looking for a switch() label or C++ scope declaration, 8234 * ignore other lines, skip {}-blocks. 8235 */ 8236 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CASE || lookfor == LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL) 8237 { 8238 if (find_last_paren(l, '{', '}') 8239 && (trypos = find_start_brace()) != NULL) 8240 { 8241 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; 8242 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8243 } 8244 continue; 8245 } 8246 8247 /* 8248 * Ignore jump labels with nothing after them. 8249 */ 8250 if (!curbuf->b_ind_js && cin_islabel()) 8251 { 8252 l = after_label(ml_get_curline()); 8253 if (l == NULL || cin_nocode(l)) 8254 continue; 8255 } 8256 8257 /* 8258 * Ignore #defines, #if, etc. 8259 * Ignore comment and empty lines. 8260 * (need to get the line again, cin_islabel() may have 8261 * unlocked it) 8262 */ 8263 l = ml_get_curline(); 8264 if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum) 8265 || cin_nocode(l)) 8266 continue; 8267 8268 /* 8269 * Are we at the start of a cpp base class declaration or 8270 * constructor initialization? 8271 */ /* XXX */ 8272 n = FALSE; 8273 if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM && curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass > 0) 8274 { 8275 n = cin_is_cpp_baseclass(&cache_cpp_baseclass); 8276 l = ml_get_curline(); 8277 } 8278 if (n) 8279 { 8280 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM) 8281 { 8282 if (cont_amount > 0) 8283 amount = cont_amount; 8284 else 8285 amount += ind_continuation; 8286 } 8287 else if (theline[0] == '{') 8288 { 8289 /* Need to find start of the declaration. */ 8290 lookfor = LOOKFOR_UNTERM; 8291 ind_continuation = 0; 8292 continue; 8293 } 8294 else 8295 /* XXX */ 8296 amount = get_baseclass_amount( 8297 cache_cpp_baseclass.lpos.col); 8298 break; 8299 } 8300 else if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS) 8301 { 8302 /* only look, whether there is a cpp base class 8303 * declaration or initialization before the opening brace. 8304 */ 8305 if (cin_isterminated(l, TRUE, FALSE)) 8306 break; 8307 else 8308 continue; 8309 } 8310 8311 /* 8312 * What happens next depends on the line being terminated. 8313 * If terminated with a ',' only consider it terminating if 8314 * there is another unterminated statement behind, eg: 8315 * 123, 8316 * sizeof 8317 * here 8318 * Otherwise check whether it is a enumeration or structure 8319 * initialisation (not indented) or a variable declaration 8320 * (indented). 8321 */ 8322 terminated = cin_isterminated(l, FALSE, TRUE); 8323 8324 if (js_cur_has_key) 8325 { 8326 js_cur_has_key = 0; /* only check the first line */ 8327 if (curbuf->b_ind_js && terminated == ',') 8328 { 8329 /* For Javascript we might be inside an object: 8330 * key: something, <- align with this 8331 * key: something 8332 * or: 8333 * key: something + <- align with this 8334 * something, 8335 * key: something 8336 */ 8337 lookfor = LOOKFOR_JS_KEY; 8338 } 8339 } 8340 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_JS_KEY && cin_has_js_key(l)) 8341 { 8342 amount = get_indent(); 8343 break; 8344 } 8345 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_COMMA) 8346 { 8347 if (tryposBrace != NULL && tryposBrace->lnum 8348 >= curwin->w_cursor.lnum) 8349 break; 8350 if (terminated == ',') 8351 /* line below current line is the one that starts a 8352 * (possibly broken) line ending in a comma. */ 8353 break; 8354 else 8355 { 8356 amount = get_indent(); 8357 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1 == ourscope) 8358 /* line above is start of the scope, thus current 8359 * line is the one that stars a (possibly broken) 8360 * line ending in a comma. */ 8361 break; 8362 } 8363 } 8364 8365 if (terminated == 0 || (lookfor != LOOKFOR_UNTERM 8366 && terminated == ',')) 8367 { 8368 if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT && 8369 (*skipwhite(l) == '[' || l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '[')) 8370 amount += ind_continuation; 8371 /* 8372 * if we're in the middle of a paren thing, 8373 * go back to the line that starts it so 8374 * we can get the right prevailing indent 8375 * if ( foo && 8376 * bar ) 8377 */ 8378 /* 8379 * Position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that 8380 * matching it will take us back to the start of the line. 8381 * Ignore a match before the start of the block. 8382 */ 8383 (void)find_last_paren(l, '(', ')'); 8384 trypos = find_match_paren(corr_ind_maxparen(&cur_curpos)); 8385 if (trypos != NULL && (trypos->lnum < tryposBrace->lnum 8386 || (trypos->lnum == tryposBrace->lnum 8387 && trypos->col < tryposBrace->col))) 8388 trypos = NULL; 8389 8390 /* 8391 * If we are looking for ',', we also look for matching 8392 * braces. 8393 */ 8394 if (trypos == NULL && terminated == ',' 8395 && find_last_paren(l, '{', '}')) 8396 trypos = find_start_brace(); 8397 8398 if (trypos != NULL) 8399 { 8400 /* 8401 * Check if we are on a case label now. This is 8402 * handled above. 8403 * case xx: if ( asdf && 8404 * asdf) 8405 */ 8406 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 8407 l = ml_get_curline(); 8408 if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l)) 8409 { 8410 ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 8411 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8412 continue; 8413 } 8414 } 8415 8416 /* 8417 * Skip over continuation lines to find the one to get the 8418 * indent from 8419 * char *usethis = "bla\ 8420 * bla", 8421 * here; 8422 */ 8423 if (terminated == ',') 8424 { 8425 while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) 8426 { 8427 l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); 8428 if (*l == NUL || l[STRLEN(l) - 1] != '\\') 8429 break; 8430 --curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 8431 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8432 } 8433 } 8434 8435 /* 8436 * Get indent and pointer to text for current line, 8437 * ignoring any jump label. XXX 8438 */ 8439 if (curbuf->b_ind_js) 8440 cur_amount = get_indent(); 8441 else 8442 cur_amount = skip_label(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, &l); 8443 /* 8444 * If this is just above the line we are indenting, and it 8445 * starts with a '{', line it up with this line. 8446 * while (not) 8447 * -> { 8448 * } 8449 */ 8450 if (terminated != ',' && lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM 8451 && theline[0] == '{') 8452 { 8453 amount = cur_amount; 8454 /* 8455 * Only add b_ind_open_extra when the current line 8456 * doesn't start with a '{', which must have a match 8457 * in the same line (scope is the same). Probably: 8458 * { 1, 2 }, 8459 * -> { 3, 4 } 8460 */ 8461 if (*skipwhite(l) != '{') 8462 amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 8463 8464 if (curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass && !curbuf->b_ind_js) 8465 { 8466 /* have to look back, whether it is a cpp base 8467 * class declaration or initialization */ 8468 lookfor = LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS; 8469 continue; 8470 } 8471 break; 8472 } 8473 8474 /* 8475 * Check if we are after an "if", "while", etc. 8476 * Also allow " } else". 8477 */ 8478 if (cin_is_cinword(l) || cin_iselse(skipwhite(l))) 8479 { 8480 /* 8481 * Found an unterminated line after an if (), line up 8482 * with the last one. 8483 * if (cond) 8484 * 100 + 8485 * -> here; 8486 */ 8487 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM 8488 || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) 8489 { 8490 if (cont_amount > 0) 8491 amount = cont_amount; 8492 else 8493 amount += ind_continuation; 8494 break; 8495 } 8496 8497 /* 8498 * If this is just above the line we are indenting, we 8499 * are finished. 8500 * while (not) 8501 * -> here; 8502 * Otherwise this indent can be used when the line 8503 * before this is terminated. 8504 * yyy; 8505 * if (stat) 8506 * while (not) 8507 * xxx; 8508 * -> here; 8509 */ 8510 amount = cur_amount; 8511 if (theline[0] == '{') 8512 amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 8513 if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM) 8514 { 8515 amount += curbuf->b_ind_level 8516 + curbuf->b_ind_no_brace; 8517 break; 8518 } 8519 8520 /* 8521 * Special trick: when expecting the while () after a 8522 * do, line up with the while() 8523 * do 8524 * x = 1; 8525 * -> here 8526 */ 8527 l = skipwhite(ml_get_curline()); 8528 if (cin_isdo(l)) 8529 { 8530 if (whilelevel == 0) 8531 break; 8532 --whilelevel; 8533 } 8534 8535 /* 8536 * When searching for a terminated line, don't use the 8537 * one between the "if" and the matching "else". 8538 * Need to use the scope of this "else". XXX 8539 * If whilelevel != 0 continue looking for a "do {". 8540 */ 8541 if (cin_iselse(l) && whilelevel == 0) 8542 { 8543 /* If we're looking at "} else", let's make sure we 8544 * find the opening brace of the enclosing scope, 8545 * not the one from "if () {". */ 8546 if (*l == '}') 8547 curwin->w_cursor.col = 8548 (colnr_T)(l - ml_get_curline()) + 1; 8549 8550 if ((trypos = find_start_brace()) == NULL 8551 || find_match(LOOKFOR_IF, trypos->lnum) 8552 == FAIL) 8553 break; 8554 } 8555 } 8556 8557 /* 8558 * If we're below an unterminated line that is not an 8559 * "if" or something, we may line up with this line or 8560 * add something for a continuation line, depending on 8561 * the line before this one. 8562 */ 8563 else 8564 { 8565 /* 8566 * Found two unterminated lines on a row, line up with 8567 * the last one. 8568 * c = 99 + 8569 * 100 + 8570 * -> here; 8571 */ 8572 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM) 8573 { 8574 /* When line ends in a comma add extra indent */ 8575 if (terminated == ',') 8576 amount += ind_continuation; 8577 break; 8578 } 8579 8580 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) 8581 { 8582 /* Found two lines ending in ',', lineup with the 8583 * lowest one, but check for cpp base class 8584 * declaration/initialization, if it is an 8585 * opening brace or we are looking just for 8586 * enumerations/initializations. */ 8587 if (terminated == ',') 8588 { 8589 if (curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass == 0) 8590 break; 8591 8592 lookfor = LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS; 8593 continue; 8594 } 8595 8596 /* Ignore unterminated lines in between, but 8597 * reduce indent. */ 8598 if (amount > cur_amount) 8599 amount = cur_amount; 8600 } 8601 else 8602 { 8603 /* 8604 * Found first unterminated line on a row, may 8605 * line up with this line, remember its indent 8606 * 100 + 8607 * -> here; 8608 */ 8609 l = ml_get_curline(); 8610 amount = cur_amount; 8611 8612 n = (int)STRLEN(l); 8613 if (terminated == ',' && (*skipwhite(l) == ']' 8614 || (n >=2 && l[n - 2] == ']'))) 8615 break; 8616 8617 /* 8618 * If previous line ends in ',', check whether we 8619 * are in an initialization or enum 8620 * struct xxx = 8621 * { 8622 * sizeof a, 8623 * 124 }; 8624 * or a normal possible continuation line. 8625 * but only, of no other statement has been found 8626 * yet. 8627 */ 8628 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_INITIAL && terminated == ',') 8629 { 8630 if (curbuf->b_ind_js) 8631 { 8632 /* Search for a line ending in a comma 8633 * and line up with the line below it 8634 * (could be the current line). 8635 * some = [ 8636 * 1, <- line up here 8637 * 2, 8638 * some = [ 8639 * 3 + <- line up here 8640 * 4 * 8641 * 5, 8642 * 6, 8643 */ 8644 if (cin_iscomment(skipwhite(l))) 8645 break; 8646 lookfor = LOOKFOR_COMMA; 8647 trypos = find_match_char('[', 8648 curbuf->b_ind_maxparen); 8649 if (trypos != NULL) 8650 { 8651 if (trypos->lnum 8652 == curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1) 8653 { 8654 /* Current line is first inside 8655 * [], line up with it. */ 8656 break; 8657 } 8658 ourscope = trypos->lnum; 8659 } 8660 } 8661 else 8662 { 8663 lookfor = LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT; 8664 cont_amount = cin_first_id_amount(); 8665 } 8666 } 8667 else 8668 { 8669 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_INITIAL 8670 && *l != NUL 8671 && l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\') 8672 /* XXX */ 8673 cont_amount = cin_get_equal_amount( 8674 curwin->w_cursor.lnum); 8675 if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM 8676 && lookfor != LOOKFOR_JS_KEY 8677 && lookfor != LOOKFOR_COMMA) 8678 lookfor = LOOKFOR_UNTERM; 8679 } 8680 } 8681 } 8682 } 8683 8684 /* 8685 * Check if we are after a while (cond); 8686 * If so: Ignore until the matching "do". 8687 */ 8688 else if (cin_iswhileofdo_end(terminated)) /* XXX */ 8689 { 8690 /* 8691 * Found an unterminated line after a while ();, line up 8692 * with the last one. 8693 * while (cond); 8694 * 100 + <- line up with this one 8695 * -> here; 8696 */ 8697 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM 8698 || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) 8699 { 8700 if (cont_amount > 0) 8701 amount = cont_amount; 8702 else 8703 amount += ind_continuation; 8704 break; 8705 } 8706 8707 if (whilelevel == 0) 8708 { 8709 lookfor = LOOKFOR_TERM; 8710 amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ 8711 if (theline[0] == '{') 8712 amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 8713 } 8714 ++whilelevel; 8715 } 8716 8717 /* 8718 * We are after a "normal" statement. 8719 * If we had another statement we can stop now and use the 8720 * indent of that other statement. 8721 * Otherwise the indent of the current statement may be used, 8722 * search backwards for the next "normal" statement. 8723 */ 8724 else 8725 { 8726 /* 8727 * Skip single break line, if before a switch label. It 8728 * may be lined up with the case label. 8729 */ 8730 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_NOBREAK 8731 && cin_isbreak(skipwhite(ml_get_curline()))) 8732 { 8733 lookfor = LOOKFOR_ANY; 8734 continue; 8735 } 8736 8737 /* 8738 * Handle "do {" line. 8739 */ 8740 if (whilelevel > 0) 8741 { 8742 l = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); 8743 if (cin_isdo(l)) 8744 { 8745 amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ 8746 --whilelevel; 8747 continue; 8748 } 8749 } 8750 8751 /* 8752 * Found a terminated line above an unterminated line. Add 8753 * the amount for a continuation line. 8754 * x = 1; 8755 * y = foo + 8756 * -> here; 8757 * or 8758 * int x = 1; 8759 * int foo, 8760 * -> here; 8761 */ 8762 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM 8763 || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) 8764 { 8765 if (cont_amount > 0) 8766 amount = cont_amount; 8767 else 8768 amount += ind_continuation; 8769 break; 8770 } 8771 8772 /* 8773 * Found a terminated line above a terminated line or "if" 8774 * etc. line. Use the amount of the line below us. 8775 * x = 1; x = 1; 8776 * if (asdf) y = 2; 8777 * while (asdf) ->here; 8778 * here; 8779 * ->foo; 8780 */ 8781 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM) 8782 { 8783 if (!lookfor_break && whilelevel == 0) 8784 break; 8785 } 8786 8787 /* 8788 * First line above the one we're indenting is terminated. 8789 * To know what needs to be done look further backward for 8790 * a terminated line. 8791 */ 8792 else 8793 { 8794 /* 8795 * position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so 8796 * that matching it will take us back to the start of 8797 * the line. Helps for: 8798 * func(asdr, 8799 * asdfasdf); 8800 * here; 8801 */ 8802 term_again: 8803 l = ml_get_curline(); 8804 if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')') 8805 && (trypos = find_match_paren( 8806 curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL) 8807 { 8808 /* 8809 * Check if we are on a case label now. This is 8810 * handled above. 8811 * case xx: if ( asdf && 8812 * asdf) 8813 */ 8814 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 8815 l = ml_get_curline(); 8816 if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l)) 8817 { 8818 ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 8819 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8820 continue; 8821 } 8822 } 8823 8824 /* When aligning with the case statement, don't align 8825 * with a statement after it. 8826 * case 1: { <-- don't use this { position 8827 * stat; 8828 * } 8829 * case 2: 8830 * stat; 8831 * } 8832 */ 8833 iscase = (curbuf->b_ind_keep_case_label 8834 && cin_iscase(l, FALSE)); 8835 8836 /* 8837 * Get indent and pointer to text for current line, 8838 * ignoring any jump label. 8839 */ 8840 amount = skip_label(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, &l); 8841 8842 if (theline[0] == '{') 8843 amount += curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 8844 /* See remark above: "Only add b_ind_open_extra.." */ 8845 l = skipwhite(l); 8846 if (*l == '{') 8847 amount -= curbuf->b_ind_open_extra; 8848 lookfor = iscase ? LOOKFOR_ANY : LOOKFOR_TERM; 8849 8850 /* 8851 * When a terminated line starts with "else" skip to 8852 * the matching "if": 8853 * else 3; 8854 * indent this; 8855 * Need to use the scope of this "else". XXX 8856 * If whilelevel != 0 continue looking for a "do {". 8857 */ 8858 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM 8859 && *l != '}' 8860 && cin_iselse(l) 8861 && whilelevel == 0) 8862 { 8863 if ((trypos = find_start_brace()) == NULL 8864 || find_match(LOOKFOR_IF, trypos->lnum) 8865 == FAIL) 8866 break; 8867 continue; 8868 } 8869 8870 /* 8871 * If we're at the end of a block, skip to the start of 8872 * that block. 8873 */ 8874 l = ml_get_curline(); 8875 if (find_last_paren(l, '{', '}') /* XXX */ 8876 && (trypos = find_start_brace()) != NULL) 8877 { 8878 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 8879 /* if not "else {" check for terminated again */ 8880 /* but skip block for "} else {" */ 8881 l = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); 8882 if (*l == '}' || !cin_iselse(l)) 8883 goto term_again; 8884 ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 8885 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8886 } 8887 } 8888 } 8889 } 8890 } 8891 } 8892 8893 /* add extra indent for a comment */ 8894 if (cin_iscomment(theline)) 8895 amount += curbuf->b_ind_comment; 8896 8897 /* subtract extra left-shift for jump labels */ 8898 if (curbuf->b_ind_jump_label > 0 && original_line_islabel) 8899 amount -= curbuf->b_ind_jump_label; 8900 8901 goto theend; 8902 } 8903 8904 /* 8905 * ok -- we're not inside any sort of structure at all! 8906 * 8907 * This means we're at the top level, and everything should 8908 * basically just match where the previous line is, except 8909 * for the lines immediately following a function declaration, 8910 * which are K&R-style parameters and need to be indented. 8911 * 8912 * if our line starts with an open brace, forget about any 8913 * prevailing indent and make sure it looks like the start 8914 * of a function 8915 */ 8916 8917 if (theline[0] == '{') 8918 { 8919 amount = curbuf->b_ind_first_open; 8920 goto theend; 8921 } 8922 8923 /* 8924 * If the NEXT line is a function declaration, the current 8925 * line needs to be indented as a function type spec. 8926 * Don't do this if the current line looks like a comment or if the 8927 * current line is terminated, ie. ends in ';', or if the current line 8928 * contains { or }: "void f() {\n if (1)" 8929 */ 8930 if (cur_curpos.lnum < curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count 8931 && !cin_nocode(theline) 8932 && vim_strchr(theline, '{') == NULL 8933 && vim_strchr(theline, '}') == NULL 8934 && !cin_ends_in(theline, (char_u *)":", NULL) 8935 && !cin_ends_in(theline, (char_u *)",", NULL) 8936 && cin_isfuncdecl(NULL, cur_curpos.lnum + 1, 8937 cur_curpos.lnum + 1) 8938 && !cin_isterminated(theline, FALSE, TRUE)) 8939 { 8940 amount = curbuf->b_ind_func_type; 8941 goto theend; 8942 } 8943 8944 /* search backwards until we find something we recognize */ 8945 amount = 0; 8946 curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos; 8947 while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) 8948 { 8949 curwin->w_cursor.lnum--; 8950 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8951 8952 l = ml_get_curline(); 8953 8954 /* 8955 * If we're in a comment or raw string now, skip to the start 8956 * of it. 8957 */ /* XXX */ 8958 if ((trypos = ind_find_start_CORS()) != NULL) 8959 { 8960 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; 8961 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 8962 continue; 8963 } 8964 8965 /* 8966 * Are we at the start of a cpp base class declaration or 8967 * constructor initialization? 8968 */ /* XXX */ 8969 n = FALSE; 8970 if (curbuf->b_ind_cpp_baseclass != 0 && theline[0] != '{') 8971 { 8972 n = cin_is_cpp_baseclass(&cache_cpp_baseclass); 8973 l = ml_get_curline(); 8974 } 8975 if (n) 8976 { 8977 /* XXX */ 8978 amount = get_baseclass_amount(cache_cpp_baseclass.lpos.col); 8979 break; 8980 } 8981 8982 /* 8983 * Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines. 8984 */ 8985 if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) 8986 continue; 8987 8988 if (cin_nocode(l)) 8989 continue; 8990 8991 /* 8992 * If the previous line ends in ',', use one level of 8993 * indentation: 8994 * int foo, 8995 * bar; 8996 * do this before checking for '}' in case of eg. 8997 * enum foobar 8998 * { 8999 * ... 9000 * } foo, 9001 * bar; 9002 */ 9003 n = 0; 9004 if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)",", NULL) 9005 || (*l != NUL && (n = l[STRLEN(l) - 1]) == '\\')) 9006 { 9007 /* take us back to opening paren */ 9008 if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')') 9009 && (trypos = find_match_paren( 9010 curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL) 9011 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 9012 9013 /* For a line ending in ',' that is a continuation line go 9014 * back to the first line with a backslash: 9015 * char *foo = "bla\ 9016 * bla", 9017 * here; 9018 */ 9019 while (n == 0 && curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) 9020 { 9021 l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); 9022 if (*l == NUL || l[STRLEN(l) - 1] != '\\') 9023 break; 9024 --curwin->w_cursor.lnum; 9025 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 9026 } 9027 9028 amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ 9029 9030 if (amount == 0) 9031 amount = cin_first_id_amount(); 9032 if (amount == 0) 9033 amount = ind_continuation; 9034 break; 9035 } 9036 9037 /* 9038 * If the line looks like a function declaration, and we're 9039 * not in a comment, put it the left margin. 9040 */ 9041 if (cin_isfuncdecl(NULL, cur_curpos.lnum, 0)) /* XXX */ 9042 break; 9043 l = ml_get_curline(); 9044 9045 /* 9046 * Finding the closing '}' of a previous function. Put 9047 * current line at the left margin. For when 'cino' has "fs". 9048 */ 9049 if (*skipwhite(l) == '}') 9050 break; 9051 9052 /* (matching {) 9053 * If the previous line ends on '};' (maybe followed by 9054 * comments) align at column 0. For example: 9055 * char *string_array[] = { "foo", 9056 * / * x * / "b};ar" }; / * foobar * / 9057 */ 9058 if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)"};", NULL)) 9059 break; 9060 9061 /* 9062 * If the previous line ends on '[' we are probably in an 9063 * array constant: 9064 * something = [ 9065 * 234, <- extra indent 9066 */ 9067 if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)"[", NULL)) 9068 { 9069 amount = get_indent() + ind_continuation; 9070 break; 9071 } 9072 9073 /* 9074 * Find a line only has a semicolon that belongs to a previous 9075 * line ending in '}', e.g. before an #endif. Don't increase 9076 * indent then. 9077 */ 9078 if (*(look = skipwhite(l)) == ';' && cin_nocode(look + 1)) 9079 { 9080 pos_T curpos_save = curwin->w_cursor; 9081 9082 while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) 9083 { 9084 look = ml_get(--curwin->w_cursor.lnum); 9085 if (!(cin_nocode(look) || cin_ispreproc_cont( 9086 &look, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum))) 9087 break; 9088 } 9089 if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 0 9090 && cin_ends_in(look, (char_u *)"}", NULL)) 9091 break; 9092 9093 curwin->w_cursor = curpos_save; 9094 } 9095 9096 /* 9097 * If the PREVIOUS line is a function declaration, the current 9098 * line (and the ones that follow) needs to be indented as 9099 * parameters. 9100 */ 9101 if (cin_isfuncdecl(&l, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0)) 9102 { 9103 amount = curbuf->b_ind_param; 9104 break; 9105 } 9106 9107 /* 9108 * If the previous line ends in ';' and the line before the 9109 * previous line ends in ',' or '\', ident to column zero: 9110 * int foo, 9111 * bar; 9112 * indent_to_0 here; 9113 */ 9114 if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)";", NULL)) 9115 { 9116 l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); 9117 if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)",", NULL) 9118 || (*l != NUL && l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\')) 9119 break; 9120 l = ml_get_curline(); 9121 } 9122 9123 /* 9124 * Doesn't look like anything interesting -- so just 9125 * use the indent of this line. 9126 * 9127 * Position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that 9128 * matching it will take us back to the start of the line. 9129 */ 9130 find_last_paren(l, '(', ')'); 9131 9132 if ((trypos = find_match_paren(curbuf->b_ind_maxparen)) != NULL) 9133 curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; 9134 amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ 9135 break; 9136 } 9137 9138 /* add extra indent for a comment */ 9139 if (cin_iscomment(theline)) 9140 amount += curbuf->b_ind_comment; 9141 9142 /* add extra indent if the previous line ended in a backslash: 9143 * "asdfasdf\ 9144 * here"; 9145 * char *foo = "asdf\ 9146 * here"; 9147 */ 9148 if (cur_curpos.lnum > 1) 9149 { 9150 l = ml_get(cur_curpos.lnum - 1); 9151 if (*l != NUL && l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\') 9152 { 9153 cur_amount = cin_get_equal_amount(cur_curpos.lnum - 1); 9154 if (cur_amount > 0) 9155 amount = cur_amount; 9156 else if (cur_amount == 0) 9157 amount += ind_continuation; 9158 } 9159 } 9160 9161 theend: 9162 if (amount < 0) 9163 amount = 0; 9164 9165 laterend: 9166 /* put the cursor back where it belongs */ 9167 curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos; 9168 9169 vim_free(linecopy); 9170 9171 return amount; 9172 } 9173 9174 static int 9175 find_match(lookfor, ourscope) 9176 int lookfor; 9177 linenr_T ourscope; 9178 { 9179 char_u *look; 9180 pos_T *theirscope; 9181 char_u *mightbeif; 9182 int elselevel; 9183 int whilelevel; 9184 9185 if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_IF) 9186 { 9187 elselevel = 1; 9188 whilelevel = 0; 9189 } 9190 else 9191 { 9192 elselevel = 0; 9193 whilelevel = 1; 9194 } 9195 9196 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 9197 9198 while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > ourscope + 1) 9199 { 9200 curwin->w_cursor.lnum--; 9201 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 9202 9203 look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); 9204 if (cin_iselse(look) 9205 || cin_isif(look) 9206 || cin_isdo(look) /* XXX */ 9207 || cin_iswhileofdo(look, curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) 9208 { 9209 /* 9210 * if we've gone outside the braces entirely, 9211 * we must be out of scope... 9212 */ 9213 theirscope = find_start_brace(); /* XXX */ 9214 if (theirscope == NULL) 9215 break; 9216 9217 /* 9218 * and if the brace enclosing this is further 9219 * back than the one enclosing the else, we're 9220 * out of luck too. 9221 */ 9222 if (theirscope->lnum < ourscope) 9223 break; 9224 9225 /* 9226 * and if they're enclosed in a *deeper* brace, 9227 * then we can ignore it because it's in a 9228 * different scope... 9229 */ 9230 if (theirscope->lnum > ourscope) 9231 continue; 9232 9233 /* 9234 * if it was an "else" (that's not an "else if") 9235 * then we need to go back to another if, so 9236 * increment elselevel 9237 */ 9238 look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); 9239 if (cin_iselse(look)) 9240 { 9241 mightbeif = cin_skipcomment(look + 4); 9242 if (!cin_isif(mightbeif)) 9243 ++elselevel; 9244 continue; 9245 } 9246 9247 /* 9248 * if it was a "while" then we need to go back to 9249 * another "do", so increment whilelevel. XXX 9250 */ 9251 if (cin_iswhileofdo(look, curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) 9252 { 9253 ++whilelevel; 9254 continue; 9255 } 9256 9257 /* If it's an "if" decrement elselevel */ 9258 look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); 9259 if (cin_isif(look)) 9260 { 9261 elselevel--; 9262 /* 9263 * When looking for an "if" ignore "while"s that 9264 * get in the way. 9265 */ 9266 if (elselevel == 0 && lookfor == LOOKFOR_IF) 9267 whilelevel = 0; 9268 } 9269 9270 /* If it's a "do" decrement whilelevel */ 9271 if (cin_isdo(look)) 9272 whilelevel--; 9273 9274 /* 9275 * if we've used up all the elses, then 9276 * this must be the if that we want! 9277 * match the indent level of that if. 9278 */ 9279 if (elselevel <= 0 && whilelevel <= 0) 9280 { 9281 return OK; 9282 } 9283 } 9284 } 9285 return FAIL; 9286 } 9287 9288 # if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO) 9289 /* 9290 * Get indent level from 'indentexpr'. 9291 */ 9292 int 9293 get_expr_indent() 9294 { 9295 int indent; 9296 pos_T save_pos; 9297 colnr_T save_curswant; 9298 int save_set_curswant; 9299 int save_State; 9300 int use_sandbox = was_set_insecurely((char_u *)"indentexpr", 9301 OPT_LOCAL); 9302 9303 /* Save and restore cursor position and curswant, in case it was changed 9304 * via :normal commands */ 9305 save_pos = curwin->w_cursor; 9306 save_curswant = curwin->w_curswant; 9307 save_set_curswant = curwin->w_set_curswant; 9308 set_vim_var_nr(VV_LNUM, curwin->w_cursor.lnum); 9309 if (use_sandbox) 9310 ++sandbox; 9311 ++textlock; 9312 indent = eval_to_number(curbuf->b_p_inde); 9313 if (use_sandbox) 9314 --sandbox; 9315 --textlock; 9316 9317 /* Restore the cursor position so that 'indentexpr' doesn't need to. 9318 * Pretend to be in Insert mode, allow cursor past end of line for "o" 9319 * command. */ 9320 save_State = State; 9321 State = INSERT; 9322 curwin->w_cursor = save_pos; 9323 curwin->w_curswant = save_curswant; 9324 curwin->w_set_curswant = save_set_curswant; 9325 check_cursor(); 9326 State = save_State; 9327 9328 /* If there is an error, just keep the current indent. */ 9329 if (indent < 0) 9330 indent = get_indent(); 9331 9332 return indent; 9333 } 9334 # endif 9335 9336 #endif /* FEAT_CINDENT */ 9337 9338 #if defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(PROTO) 9339 9340 static int lisp_match __ARGS((char_u *p)); 9341 9342 static int 9343 lisp_match(p) 9344 char_u *p; 9345 { 9346 char_u buf[LSIZE]; 9347 int len; 9348 char_u *word = *curbuf->b_p_lw != NUL ? curbuf->b_p_lw : p_lispwords; 9349 9350 while (*word != NUL) 9351 { 9352 (void)copy_option_part(&word, buf, LSIZE, ","); 9353 len = (int)STRLEN(buf); 9354 if (STRNCMP(buf, p, len) == 0 && p[len] == ' ') 9355 return TRUE; 9356 } 9357 return FALSE; 9358 } 9359 9360 /* 9361 * When 'p' is present in 'cpoptions, a Vi compatible method is used. 9362 * The incompatible newer method is quite a bit better at indenting 9363 * code in lisp-like languages than the traditional one; it's still 9364 * mostly heuristics however -- Dirk van Deun, [email protected] 9365 * 9366 * TODO: 9367 * Findmatch() should be adapted for lisp, also to make showmatch 9368 * work correctly: now (v5.3) it seems all C/C++ oriented: 9369 * - it does not recognize the #\( and #\) notations as character literals 9370 * - it doesn't know about comments starting with a semicolon 9371 * - it incorrectly interprets '(' as a character literal 9372 * All this messes up get_lisp_indent in some rare cases. 9373 * Update from Sergey Khorev: 9374 * I tried to fix the first two issues. 9375 */ 9376 int 9377 get_lisp_indent() 9378 { 9379 pos_T *pos, realpos, paren; 9380 int amount; 9381 char_u *that; 9382 colnr_T col; 9383 colnr_T firsttry; 9384 int parencount, quotecount; 9385 int vi_lisp; 9386 9387 /* Set vi_lisp to use the vi-compatible method */ 9388 vi_lisp = (vim_strchr(p_cpo, CPO_LISP) != NULL); 9389 9390 realpos = curwin->w_cursor; 9391 curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; 9392 9393 if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, '(')) == NULL) 9394 pos = findmatch(NULL, '['); 9395 else 9396 { 9397 paren = *pos; 9398 pos = findmatch(NULL, '['); 9399 if (pos == NULL || ltp(pos, &paren)) 9400 pos = &paren; 9401 } 9402 if (pos != NULL) 9403 { 9404 /* Extra trick: Take the indent of the first previous non-white 9405 * line that is at the same () level. */ 9406 amount = -1; 9407 parencount = 0; 9408 9409 while (--curwin->w_cursor.lnum >= pos->lnum) 9410 { 9411 if (linewhite(curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) 9412 continue; 9413 for (that = ml_get_curline(); *that != NUL; ++that) 9414 { 9415 if (*that == ';') 9416 { 9417 while (*(that + 1) != NUL) 9418 ++that; 9419 continue; 9420 } 9421 if (*that == '\\') 9422 { 9423 if (*(that + 1) != NUL) 9424 ++that; 9425 continue; 9426 } 9427 if (*that == '"' && *(that + 1) != NUL) 9428 { 9429 while (*++that && *that != '"') 9430 { 9431 /* skipping escaped characters in the string */ 9432 if (*that == '\\') 9433 { 9434 if (*++that == NUL) 9435 break; 9436 if (that[1] == NUL) 9437 { 9438 ++that; 9439 break; 9440 } 9441 } 9442 } 9443 } 9444 if (*that == '(' || *that == '[') 9445 ++parencount; 9446 else if (*that == ')' || *that == ']') 9447 --parencount; 9448 } 9449 if (parencount == 0) 9450 { 9451 amount = get_indent(); 9452 break; 9453 } 9454 } 9455 9456 if (amount == -1) 9457 { 9458 curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; 9459 curwin->w_cursor.col = pos->col; 9460 col = pos->col; 9461 9462 that = ml_get_curline(); 9463 9464 if (vi_lisp && get_indent() == 0) 9465 amount = 2; 9466 else 9467 { 9468 char_u *line = that; 9469 9470 amount = 0; 9471 while (*that && col) 9472 { 9473 amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv(line, &that, (colnr_T)amount); 9474 col--; 9475 } 9476 9477 /* 9478 * Some keywords require "body" indenting rules (the 9479 * non-standard-lisp ones are Scheme special forms): 9480 * 9481 * (let ((a 1)) instead (let ((a 1)) 9482 * (...)) of (...)) 9483 */ 9484 9485 if (!vi_lisp && (*that == '(' || *that == '[') 9486 && lisp_match(that + 1)) 9487 amount += 2; 9488 else 9489 { 9490 that++; 9491 amount++; 9492 firsttry = amount; 9493 9494 while (vim_iswhite(*that)) 9495 { 9496 amount += lbr_chartabsize(line, that, (colnr_T)amount); 9497 ++that; 9498 } 9499 9500 if (*that && *that != ';') /* not a comment line */ 9501 { 9502 /* test *that != '(' to accommodate first let/do 9503 * argument if it is more than one line */ 9504 if (!vi_lisp && *that != '(' && *that != '[') 9505 firsttry++; 9506 9507 parencount = 0; 9508 quotecount = 0; 9509 9510 if (vi_lisp 9511 || (*that != '"' 9512 && *that != '\'' 9513 && *that != '#' 9514 && (*that < '0' || *that > '9'))) 9515 { 9516 while (*that 9517 && (!vim_iswhite(*that) 9518 || quotecount 9519 || parencount) 9520 && (!((*that == '(' || *that == '[') 9521 && !quotecount 9522 && !parencount 9523 && vi_lisp))) 9524 { 9525 if (*that == '"') 9526 quotecount = !quotecount; 9527 if ((*that == '(' || *that == '[') 9528 && !quotecount) 9529 ++parencount; 9530 if ((*that == ')' || *that == ']') 9531 && !quotecount) 9532 --parencount; 9533 if (*that == '\\' && *(that+1) != NUL) 9534 amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv( 9535 line, &that, (colnr_T)amount); 9536 amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv( 9537 line, &that, (colnr_T)amount); 9538 } 9539 } 9540 while (vim_iswhite(*that)) 9541 { 9542 amount += lbr_chartabsize( 9543 line, that, (colnr_T)amount); 9544 that++; 9545 } 9546 if (!*that || *that == ';') 9547 amount = firsttry; 9548 } 9549 } 9550 } 9551 } 9552 } 9553 else 9554 amount = 0; /* no matching '(' or '[' found, use zero indent */ 9555 9556 curwin->w_cursor = realpos; 9557 9558 return amount; 9559 } 9560 #endif /* FEAT_LISP */ 9561 9562 void 9563 prepare_to_exit() 9564 { 9565 #if defined(SIGHUP) && defined(SIG_IGN) 9566 /* Ignore SIGHUP, because a dropped connection causes a read error, which 9567 * makes Vim exit and then handling SIGHUP causes various reentrance 9568 * problems. */ 9569 signal(SIGHUP, SIG_IGN); 9570 #endif 9571 9572 #ifdef FEAT_GUI 9573 if (gui.in_use) 9574 { 9575 gui.dying = TRUE; 9576 out_trash(); /* trash any pending output */ 9577 } 9578 else 9579 #endif 9580 { 9581 windgoto((int)Rows - 1, 0); 9582 9583 /* 9584 * Switch terminal mode back now, so messages end up on the "normal" 9585 * screen (if there are two screens). 9586 */ 9587 settmode(TMODE_COOK); 9588 #ifdef WIN3264 9589 if (can_end_termcap_mode(FALSE) == TRUE) 9590 #endif 9591 stoptermcap(); 9592 out_flush(); 9593 } 9594 } 9595 9596 /* 9597 * Preserve files and exit. 9598 * When called IObuff must contain a message. 9599 * NOTE: This may be called from deathtrap() in a signal handler, avoid unsafe 9600 * functions, such as allocating memory. 9601 */ 9602 void 9603 preserve_exit() 9604 { 9605 buf_T *buf; 9606 9607 prepare_to_exit(); 9608 9609 /* Setting this will prevent free() calls. That avoids calling free() 9610 * recursively when free() was invoked with a bad pointer. */ 9611 really_exiting = TRUE; 9612 9613 out_str(IObuff); 9614 screen_start(); /* don't know where cursor is now */ 9615 out_flush(); 9616 9617 ml_close_notmod(); /* close all not-modified buffers */ 9618 9619 for (buf = firstbuf; buf != NULL; buf = buf->b_next) 9620 { 9621 if (buf->b_ml.ml_mfp != NULL && buf->b_ml.ml_mfp->mf_fname != NULL) 9622 { 9623 OUT_STR("Vim: preserving files...\n"); 9624 screen_start(); /* don't know where cursor is now */ 9625 out_flush(); 9626 ml_sync_all(FALSE, FALSE); /* preserve all swap files */ 9627 break; 9628 } 9629 } 9630 9631 ml_close_all(FALSE); /* close all memfiles, without deleting */ 9632 9633 OUT_STR("Vim: Finished.\n"); 9634 9635 getout(1); 9636 } 9637 9638 /* 9639 * return TRUE if "fname" exists. 9640 */ 9641 int 9642 vim_fexists(fname) 9643 char_u *fname; 9644 { 9645 struct stat st; 9646 9647 if (mch_stat((char *)fname, &st)) 9648 return FALSE; 9649 return TRUE; 9650 } 9651 9652 /* 9653 * Check for CTRL-C pressed, but only once in a while. 9654 * Should be used instead of ui_breakcheck() for functions that check for 9655 * each line in the file. Calling ui_breakcheck() each time takes too much 9656 * time, because it can be a system call. 9657 */ 9658 9659 #ifndef BREAKCHECK_SKIP 9660 # ifdef FEAT_GUI /* assume the GUI only runs on fast computers */ 9661 # define BREAKCHECK_SKIP 200 9662 # else 9663 # define BREAKCHECK_SKIP 32 9664 # endif 9665 #endif 9666 9667 static int breakcheck_count = 0; 9668 9669 void 9670 line_breakcheck() 9671 { 9672 if (++breakcheck_count >= BREAKCHECK_SKIP) 9673 { 9674 breakcheck_count = 0; 9675 ui_breakcheck(); 9676 } 9677 } 9678 9679 /* 9680 * Like line_breakcheck() but check 10 times less often. 9681 */ 9682 void 9683 fast_breakcheck() 9684 { 9685 if (++breakcheck_count >= BREAKCHECK_SKIP * 10) 9686 { 9687 breakcheck_count = 0; 9688 ui_breakcheck(); 9689 } 9690 } 9691 9692 /* 9693 * Invoke expand_wildcards() for one pattern. 9694 * Expand items like "%:h" before the expansion. 9695 * Returns OK or FAIL. 9696 */ 9697 int 9698 expand_wildcards_eval(pat, num_file, file, flags) 9699 char_u **pat; /* pointer to input pattern */ 9700 int *num_file; /* resulting number of files */ 9701 char_u ***file; /* array of resulting files */ 9702 int flags; /* EW_DIR, etc. */ 9703 { 9704 int ret = FAIL; 9705 char_u *eval_pat = NULL; 9706 char_u *exp_pat = *pat; 9707 char_u *ignored_msg; 9708 int usedlen; 9709 9710 if (*exp_pat == '%' || *exp_pat == '#' || *exp_pat == '<') 9711 { 9712 ++emsg_off; 9713 eval_pat = eval_vars(exp_pat, exp_pat, &usedlen, 9714 NULL, &ignored_msg, NULL); 9715 --emsg_off; 9716 if (eval_pat != NULL) 9717 exp_pat = concat_str(eval_pat, exp_pat + usedlen); 9718 } 9719 9720 if (exp_pat != NULL) 9721 ret = expand_wildcards(1, &exp_pat, num_file, file, flags); 9722 9723 if (eval_pat != NULL) 9724 { 9725 vim_free(exp_pat); 9726 vim_free(eval_pat); 9727 } 9728 9729 return ret; 9730 } 9731 9732 /* 9733 * Expand wildcards. Calls gen_expand_wildcards() and removes files matching 9734 * 'wildignore'. 9735 * Returns OK or FAIL. When FAIL then "num_files" won't be set. 9736 */ 9737 int 9738 expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_files, files, flags) 9739 int num_pat; /* number of input patterns */ 9740 char_u **pat; /* array of input patterns */ 9741 int *num_files; /* resulting number of files */ 9742 char_u ***files; /* array of resulting files */ 9743 int flags; /* EW_DIR, etc. */ 9744 { 9745 int retval; 9746 int i, j; 9747 char_u *p; 9748 int non_suf_match; /* number without matching suffix */ 9749 9750 retval = gen_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_files, files, flags); 9751 9752 /* When keeping all matches, return here */ 9753 if ((flags & EW_KEEPALL) || retval == FAIL) 9754 return retval; 9755 9756 #ifdef FEAT_WILDIGN 9757 /* 9758 * Remove names that match 'wildignore'. 9759 */ 9760 if (*p_wig) 9761 { 9762 char_u *ffname; 9763 9764 /* check all files in (*files)[] */ 9765 for (i = 0; i < *num_files; ++i) 9766 { 9767 ffname = FullName_save((*files)[i], FALSE); 9768 if (ffname == NULL) /* out of memory */ 9769 break; 9770 # ifdef VMS 9771 vms_remove_version(ffname); 9772 # endif 9773 if (match_file_list(p_wig, (*files)[i], ffname)) 9774 { 9775 /* remove this matching files from the list */ 9776 vim_free((*files)[i]); 9777 for (j = i; j + 1 < *num_files; ++j) 9778 (*files)[j] = (*files)[j + 1]; 9779 --*num_files; 9780 --i; 9781 } 9782 vim_free(ffname); 9783 } 9784 9785 /* If the number of matches is now zero, we fail. */ 9786 if (*num_files == 0) 9787 { 9788 vim_free(*files); 9789 *files = NULL; 9790 return FAIL; 9791 } 9792 } 9793 #endif 9794 9795 /* 9796 * Move the names where 'suffixes' match to the end. 9797 */ 9798 if (*num_files > 1) 9799 { 9800 non_suf_match = 0; 9801 for (i = 0; i < *num_files; ++i) 9802 { 9803 if (!match_suffix((*files)[i])) 9804 { 9805 /* 9806 * Move the name without matching suffix to the front 9807 * of the list. 9808 */ 9809 p = (*files)[i]; 9810 for (j = i; j > non_suf_match; --j) 9811 (*files)[j] = (*files)[j - 1]; 9812 (*files)[non_suf_match++] = p; 9813 } 9814 } 9815 } 9816 9817 return retval; 9818 } 9819 9820 /* 9821 * Return TRUE if "fname" matches with an entry in 'suffixes'. 9822 */ 9823 int 9824 match_suffix(fname) 9825 char_u *fname; 9826 { 9827 int fnamelen, setsuflen; 9828 char_u *setsuf; 9829 #define MAXSUFLEN 30 /* maximum length of a file suffix */ 9830 char_u suf_buf[MAXSUFLEN]; 9831 9832 fnamelen = (int)STRLEN(fname); 9833 setsuflen = 0; 9834 for (setsuf = p_su; *setsuf; ) 9835 { 9836 setsuflen = copy_option_part(&setsuf, suf_buf, MAXSUFLEN, ".,"); 9837 if (setsuflen == 0) 9838 { 9839 char_u *tail = gettail(fname); 9840 9841 /* empty entry: match name without a '.' */ 9842 if (vim_strchr(tail, '.') == NULL) 9843 { 9844 setsuflen = 1; 9845 break; 9846 } 9847 } 9848 else 9849 { 9850 if (fnamelen >= setsuflen 9851 && fnamencmp(suf_buf, fname + fnamelen - setsuflen, 9852 (size_t)setsuflen) == 0) 9853 break; 9854 setsuflen = 0; 9855 } 9856 } 9857 return (setsuflen != 0); 9858 } 9859 9860 #if !defined(NO_EXPANDPATH) || defined(PROTO) 9861 9862 # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK 9863 static int vim_backtick __ARGS((char_u *p)); 9864 static int expand_backtick __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u *pat, int flags)); 9865 # endif 9866 9867 # if defined(MSDOS) || defined(FEAT_GUI_W16) || defined(WIN3264) 9868 /* 9869 * File name expansion code for MS-DOS, Win16 and Win32. It's here because 9870 * it's shared between these systems. 9871 */ 9872 # if defined(DJGPP) || defined(PROTO) 9873 # define _cdecl /* DJGPP doesn't have this */ 9874 # else 9875 # ifdef __BORLANDC__ 9876 # define _cdecl _RTLENTRYF 9877 # endif 9878 # endif 9879 9880 /* 9881 * comparison function for qsort in dos_expandpath() 9882 */ 9883 static int _cdecl 9884 pstrcmp(const void *a, const void *b) 9885 { 9886 return (pathcmp(*(char **)a, *(char **)b, -1)); 9887 } 9888 9889 # ifndef WIN3264 9890 static void 9891 namelowcpy( 9892 char_u *d, 9893 char_u *s) 9894 { 9895 # ifdef DJGPP 9896 if (USE_LONG_FNAME) /* don't lower case on Windows 95/NT systems */ 9897 while (*s) 9898 *d++ = *s++; 9899 else 9900 # endif 9901 while (*s) 9902 *d++ = TOLOWER_LOC(*s++); 9903 *d = NUL; 9904 } 9905 # endif 9906 9907 /* 9908 * Recursively expand one path component into all matching files and/or 9909 * directories. Adds matches to "gap". Handles "*", "?", "[a-z]", "**", etc. 9910 * Return the number of matches found. 9911 * "path" has backslashes before chars that are not to be expanded, starting 9912 * at "path[wildoff]". 9913 * Return the number of matches found. 9914 * NOTE: much of this is identical to unix_expandpath(), keep in sync! 9915 */ 9916 static int 9917 dos_expandpath( 9918 garray_T *gap, 9919 char_u *path, 9920 int wildoff, 9921 int flags, /* EW_* flags */ 9922 int didstar) /* expanded "**" once already */ 9923 { 9924 char_u *buf; 9925 char_u *path_end; 9926 char_u *p, *s, *e; 9927 int start_len = gap->ga_len; 9928 char_u *pat; 9929 regmatch_T regmatch; 9930 int starts_with_dot; 9931 int matches; 9932 int len; 9933 int starstar = FALSE; 9934 static int stardepth = 0; /* depth for "**" expansion */ 9935 #ifdef WIN3264 9936 WIN32_FIND_DATA fb; 9937 HANDLE hFind = (HANDLE)0; 9938 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 9939 WIN32_FIND_DATAW wfb; 9940 WCHAR *wn = NULL; /* UCS-2 name, NULL when not used. */ 9941 # endif 9942 #else 9943 struct ffblk fb; 9944 #endif 9945 char_u *matchname; 9946 int ok; 9947 9948 /* Expanding "**" may take a long time, check for CTRL-C. */ 9949 if (stardepth > 0) 9950 { 9951 ui_breakcheck(); 9952 if (got_int) 9953 return 0; 9954 } 9955 9956 /* Make room for file name. When doing encoding conversion the actual 9957 * length may be quite a bit longer, thus use the maximum possible length. */ 9958 buf = alloc((int)MAXPATHL); 9959 if (buf == NULL) 9960 return 0; 9961 9962 /* 9963 * Find the first part in the path name that contains a wildcard or a ~1. 9964 * Copy it into buf, including the preceding characters. 9965 */ 9966 p = buf; 9967 s = buf; 9968 e = NULL; 9969 path_end = path; 9970 while (*path_end != NUL) 9971 { 9972 /* May ignore a wildcard that has a backslash before it; it will 9973 * be removed by rem_backslash() or file_pat_to_reg_pat() below. */ 9974 if (path_end >= path + wildoff && rem_backslash(path_end)) 9975 *p++ = *path_end++; 9976 else if (*path_end == '\\' || *path_end == ':' || *path_end == '/') 9977 { 9978 if (e != NULL) 9979 break; 9980 s = p + 1; 9981 } 9982 else if (path_end >= path + wildoff 9983 && vim_strchr((char_u *)"*?[~", *path_end) != NULL) 9984 e = p; 9985 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 9986 if (has_mbyte) 9987 { 9988 len = (*mb_ptr2len)(path_end); 9989 STRNCPY(p, path_end, len); 9990 p += len; 9991 path_end += len; 9992 } 9993 else 9994 #endif 9995 *p++ = *path_end++; 9996 } 9997 e = p; 9998 *e = NUL; 9999 10000 /* now we have one wildcard component between s and e */ 10001 /* Remove backslashes between "wildoff" and the start of the wildcard 10002 * component. */ 10003 for (p = buf + wildoff; p < s; ++p) 10004 if (rem_backslash(p)) 10005 { 10006 STRMOVE(p, p + 1); 10007 --e; 10008 --s; 10009 } 10010 10011 /* Check for "**" between "s" and "e". */ 10012 for (p = s; p < e; ++p) 10013 if (p[0] == '*' && p[1] == '*') 10014 starstar = TRUE; 10015 10016 starts_with_dot = (*s == '.'); 10017 pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(s, e, NULL, FALSE); 10018 if (pat == NULL) 10019 { 10020 vim_free(buf); 10021 return 0; 10022 } 10023 10024 /* compile the regexp into a program */ 10025 if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD)) 10026 ++emsg_silent; 10027 regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE; /* Always ignore case */ 10028 regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC); 10029 if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD)) 10030 --emsg_silent; 10031 vim_free(pat); 10032 10033 if (regmatch.regprog == NULL && (flags & EW_NOTWILD) == 0) 10034 { 10035 vim_free(buf); 10036 return 0; 10037 } 10038 10039 /* remember the pattern or file name being looked for */ 10040 matchname = vim_strsave(s); 10041 10042 /* If "**" is by itself, this is the first time we encounter it and more 10043 * is following then find matches without any directory. */ 10044 if (!didstar && stardepth < 100 && starstar && e - s == 2 10045 && *path_end == '/') 10046 { 10047 STRCPY(s, path_end + 1); 10048 ++stardepth; 10049 (void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, (int)(s - buf), flags, TRUE); 10050 --stardepth; 10051 } 10052 10053 /* Scan all files in the directory with "dir/ *.*" */ 10054 STRCPY(s, "*.*"); 10055 #ifdef WIN3264 10056 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 10057 if (enc_codepage >= 0 && (int)GetACP() != enc_codepage) 10058 { 10059 /* The active codepage differs from 'encoding'. Attempt using the 10060 * wide function. If it fails because it is not implemented fall back 10061 * to the non-wide version (for Windows 98) */ 10062 wn = enc_to_utf16(buf, NULL); 10063 if (wn != NULL) 10064 { 10065 hFind = FindFirstFileW(wn, &wfb); 10066 if (hFind == INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE 10067 && GetLastError() == ERROR_CALL_NOT_IMPLEMENTED) 10068 { 10069 vim_free(wn); 10070 wn = NULL; 10071 } 10072 } 10073 } 10074 10075 if (wn == NULL) 10076 # endif 10077 hFind = FindFirstFile(buf, &fb); 10078 ok = (hFind != INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE); 10079 #else 10080 /* If we are expanding wildcards we try both files and directories */ 10081 ok = (findfirst((char *)buf, &fb, 10082 (*path_end != NUL || (flags & EW_DIR)) ? FA_DIREC : 0) == 0); 10083 #endif 10084 10085 while (ok) 10086 { 10087 #ifdef WIN3264 10088 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 10089 if (wn != NULL) 10090 p = utf16_to_enc(wfb.cFileName, NULL); /* p is allocated here */ 10091 else 10092 # endif 10093 p = (char_u *)fb.cFileName; 10094 #else 10095 p = (char_u *)fb.ff_name; 10096 #endif 10097 /* Ignore entries starting with a dot, unless when asked for. Accept 10098 * all entries found with "matchname". */ 10099 if ((p[0] != '.' || starts_with_dot) 10100 && (matchname == NULL 10101 || (regmatch.regprog != NULL 10102 && vim_regexec(®match, p, (colnr_T)0)) 10103 || ((flags & EW_NOTWILD) 10104 && fnamencmp(path + (s - buf), p, e - s) == 0))) 10105 { 10106 #ifdef WIN3264 10107 STRCPY(s, p); 10108 #else 10109 namelowcpy(s, p); 10110 #endif 10111 len = (int)STRLEN(buf); 10112 10113 if (starstar && stardepth < 100) 10114 { 10115 /* For "**" in the pattern first go deeper in the tree to 10116 * find matches. */ 10117 STRCPY(buf + len, "/**"); 10118 STRCPY(buf + len + 3, path_end); 10119 ++stardepth; 10120 (void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, TRUE); 10121 --stardepth; 10122 } 10123 10124 STRCPY(buf + len, path_end); 10125 if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(path_end)) 10126 { 10127 /* need to expand another component of the path */ 10128 /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */ 10129 (void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, FALSE); 10130 } 10131 else 10132 { 10133 /* no more wildcards, check if there is a match */ 10134 /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */ 10135 if (*path_end != 0) 10136 backslash_halve(buf + len + 1); 10137 if (mch_getperm(buf) >= 0) /* add existing file */ 10138 addfile(gap, buf, flags); 10139 } 10140 } 10141 10142 #ifdef WIN3264 10143 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 10144 if (wn != NULL) 10145 { 10146 vim_free(p); 10147 ok = FindNextFileW(hFind, &wfb); 10148 } 10149 else 10150 # endif 10151 ok = FindNextFile(hFind, &fb); 10152 #else 10153 ok = (findnext(&fb) == 0); 10154 #endif 10155 10156 /* If no more matches and no match was used, try expanding the name 10157 * itself. Finds the long name of a short filename. */ 10158 if (!ok && matchname != NULL && gap->ga_len == start_len) 10159 { 10160 STRCPY(s, matchname); 10161 #ifdef WIN3264 10162 FindClose(hFind); 10163 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 10164 if (wn != NULL) 10165 { 10166 vim_free(wn); 10167 wn = enc_to_utf16(buf, NULL); 10168 if (wn != NULL) 10169 hFind = FindFirstFileW(wn, &wfb); 10170 } 10171 if (wn == NULL) 10172 # endif 10173 hFind = FindFirstFile(buf, &fb); 10174 ok = (hFind != INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE); 10175 #else 10176 ok = (findfirst((char *)buf, &fb, 10177 (*path_end != NUL || (flags & EW_DIR)) ? FA_DIREC : 0) == 0); 10178 #endif 10179 vim_free(matchname); 10180 matchname = NULL; 10181 } 10182 } 10183 10184 #ifdef WIN3264 10185 FindClose(hFind); 10186 # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 10187 vim_free(wn); 10188 # endif 10189 #endif 10190 vim_free(buf); 10191 vim_regfree(regmatch.regprog); 10192 vim_free(matchname); 10193 10194 matches = gap->ga_len - start_len; 10195 if (matches > 0) 10196 qsort(((char_u **)gap->ga_data) + start_len, (size_t)matches, 10197 sizeof(char_u *), pstrcmp); 10198 return matches; 10199 } 10200 10201 int 10202 mch_expandpath( 10203 garray_T *gap, 10204 char_u *path, 10205 int flags) /* EW_* flags */ 10206 { 10207 return dos_expandpath(gap, path, 0, flags, FALSE); 10208 } 10209 # endif /* MSDOS || FEAT_GUI_W16 || WIN3264 */ 10210 10211 #if (defined(UNIX) && !defined(VMS)) || defined(USE_UNIXFILENAME) \ 10212 || defined(PROTO) 10213 /* 10214 * Unix style wildcard expansion code. 10215 * It's here because it's used both for Unix and Mac. 10216 */ 10217 static int pstrcmp __ARGS((const void *, const void *)); 10218 10219 static int 10220 pstrcmp(a, b) 10221 const void *a, *b; 10222 { 10223 return (pathcmp(*(char **)a, *(char **)b, -1)); 10224 } 10225 10226 /* 10227 * Recursively expand one path component into all matching files and/or 10228 * directories. Adds matches to "gap". Handles "*", "?", "[a-z]", "**", etc. 10229 * "path" has backslashes before chars that are not to be expanded, starting 10230 * at "path + wildoff". 10231 * Return the number of matches found. 10232 * NOTE: much of this is identical to dos_expandpath(), keep in sync! 10233 */ 10234 int 10235 unix_expandpath(gap, path, wildoff, flags, didstar) 10236 garray_T *gap; 10237 char_u *path; 10238 int wildoff; 10239 int flags; /* EW_* flags */ 10240 int didstar; /* expanded "**" once already */ 10241 { 10242 char_u *buf; 10243 char_u *path_end; 10244 char_u *p, *s, *e; 10245 int start_len = gap->ga_len; 10246 char_u *pat; 10247 regmatch_T regmatch; 10248 int starts_with_dot; 10249 int matches; 10250 int len; 10251 int starstar = FALSE; 10252 static int stardepth = 0; /* depth for "**" expansion */ 10253 10254 DIR *dirp; 10255 struct dirent *dp; 10256 10257 /* Expanding "**" may take a long time, check for CTRL-C. */ 10258 if (stardepth > 0) 10259 { 10260 ui_breakcheck(); 10261 if (got_int) 10262 return 0; 10263 } 10264 10265 /* make room for file name */ 10266 buf = alloc((int)STRLEN(path) + BASENAMELEN + 5); 10267 if (buf == NULL) 10268 return 0; 10269 10270 /* 10271 * Find the first part in the path name that contains a wildcard. 10272 * When EW_ICASE is set every letter is considered to be a wildcard. 10273 * Copy it into "buf", including the preceding characters. 10274 */ 10275 p = buf; 10276 s = buf; 10277 e = NULL; 10278 path_end = path; 10279 while (*path_end != NUL) 10280 { 10281 /* May ignore a wildcard that has a backslash before it; it will 10282 * be removed by rem_backslash() or file_pat_to_reg_pat() below. */ 10283 if (path_end >= path + wildoff && rem_backslash(path_end)) 10284 *p++ = *path_end++; 10285 else if (*path_end == '/') 10286 { 10287 if (e != NULL) 10288 break; 10289 s = p + 1; 10290 } 10291 else if (path_end >= path + wildoff 10292 && (vim_strchr((char_u *)"*?[{~$", *path_end) != NULL 10293 || (!p_fic && (flags & EW_ICASE) 10294 && isalpha(PTR2CHAR(path_end))))) 10295 e = p; 10296 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE 10297 if (has_mbyte) 10298 { 10299 len = (*mb_ptr2len)(path_end); 10300 STRNCPY(p, path_end, len); 10301 p += len; 10302 path_end += len; 10303 } 10304 else 10305 #endif 10306 *p++ = *path_end++; 10307 } 10308 e = p; 10309 *e = NUL; 10310 10311 /* Now we have one wildcard component between "s" and "e". */ 10312 /* Remove backslashes between "wildoff" and the start of the wildcard 10313 * component. */ 10314 for (p = buf + wildoff; p < s; ++p) 10315 if (rem_backslash(p)) 10316 { 10317 STRMOVE(p, p + 1); 10318 --e; 10319 --s; 10320 } 10321 10322 /* Check for "**" between "s" and "e". */ 10323 for (p = s; p < e; ++p) 10324 if (p[0] == '*' && p[1] == '*') 10325 starstar = TRUE; 10326 10327 /* convert the file pattern to a regexp pattern */ 10328 starts_with_dot = (*s == '.'); 10329 pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(s, e, NULL, FALSE); 10330 if (pat == NULL) 10331 { 10332 vim_free(buf); 10333 return 0; 10334 } 10335 10336 /* compile the regexp into a program */ 10337 if (flags & EW_ICASE) 10338 regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE; /* 'wildignorecase' set */ 10339 else 10340 regmatch.rm_ic = p_fic; /* ignore case when 'fileignorecase' is set */ 10341 if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD)) 10342 ++emsg_silent; 10343 regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC); 10344 if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD)) 10345 --emsg_silent; 10346 vim_free(pat); 10347 10348 if (regmatch.regprog == NULL && (flags & EW_NOTWILD) == 0) 10349 { 10350 vim_free(buf); 10351 return 0; 10352 } 10353 10354 /* If "**" is by itself, this is the first time we encounter it and more 10355 * is following then find matches without any directory. */ 10356 if (!didstar && stardepth < 100 && starstar && e - s == 2 10357 && *path_end == '/') 10358 { 10359 STRCPY(s, path_end + 1); 10360 ++stardepth; 10361 (void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, (int)(s - buf), flags, TRUE); 10362 --stardepth; 10363 } 10364 10365 /* open the directory for scanning */ 10366 *s = NUL; 10367 dirp = opendir(*buf == NUL ? "." : (char *)buf); 10368 10369 /* Find all matching entries */ 10370 if (dirp != NULL) 10371 { 10372 for (;;) 10373 { 10374 dp = readdir(dirp); 10375 if (dp == NULL) 10376 break; 10377 if ((dp->d_name[0] != '.' || starts_with_dot) 10378 && ((regmatch.regprog != NULL && vim_regexec(®match, 10379 (char_u *)dp->d_name, (colnr_T)0)) 10380 || ((flags & EW_NOTWILD) 10381 && fnamencmp(path + (s - buf), dp->d_name, e - s) == 0))) 10382 { 10383 STRCPY(s, dp->d_name); 10384 len = STRLEN(buf); 10385 10386 if (starstar && stardepth < 100) 10387 { 10388 /* For "**" in the pattern first go deeper in the tree to 10389 * find matches. */ 10390 STRCPY(buf + len, "/**"); 10391 STRCPY(buf + len + 3, path_end); 10392 ++stardepth; 10393 (void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, TRUE); 10394 --stardepth; 10395 } 10396 10397 STRCPY(buf + len, path_end); 10398 if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(path_end)) /* handle more wildcards */ 10399 { 10400 /* need to expand another component of the path */ 10401 /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */ 10402 (void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, FALSE); 10403 } 10404 else 10405 { 10406 struct stat sb; 10407 10408 /* no more wildcards, check if there is a match */ 10409 /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */ 10410 if (*path_end != NUL) 10411 backslash_halve(buf + len + 1); 10412 /* add existing file or symbolic link */ 10413 if ((flags & EW_ALLLINKS) ? mch_lstat((char *)buf, &sb) >= 0 10414 : mch_getperm(buf) >= 0) 10415 { 10416 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT 10417 size_t precomp_len = STRLEN(buf)+1; 10418 char_u *precomp_buf = 10419 mac_precompose_path(buf, precomp_len, &precomp_len); 10420 10421 if (precomp_buf) 10422 { 10423 mch_memmove(buf, precomp_buf, precomp_len); 10424 vim_free(precomp_buf); 10425 } 10426 #endif 10427 addfile(gap, buf, flags); 10428 } 10429 } 10430 } 10431 } 10432 10433 closedir(dirp); 10434 } 10435 10436 vim_free(buf); 10437 vim_regfree(regmatch.regprog); 10438 10439 matches = gap->ga_len - start_len; 10440 if (matches > 0) 10441 qsort(((char_u **)gap->ga_data) + start_len, matches, 10442 sizeof(char_u *), pstrcmp); 10443 return matches; 10444 } 10445 #endif 10446 10447 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) 10448 static int find_previous_pathsep __ARGS((char_u *path, char_u **psep)); 10449 static int is_unique __ARGS((char_u *maybe_unique, garray_T *gap, int i)); 10450 static void expand_path_option __ARGS((char_u *curdir, garray_T *gap)); 10451 static char_u *get_path_cutoff __ARGS((char_u *fname, garray_T *gap)); 10452 static void uniquefy_paths __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u *pattern)); 10453 static int expand_in_path __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u *pattern, int flags)); 10454 10455 /* 10456 * Moves "*psep" back to the previous path separator in "path". 10457 * Returns FAIL is "*psep" ends up at the beginning of "path". 10458 */ 10459 static int 10460 find_previous_pathsep(path, psep) 10461 char_u *path; 10462 char_u **psep; 10463 { 10464 /* skip the current separator */ 10465 if (*psep > path && vim_ispathsep(**psep)) 10466 --*psep; 10467 10468 /* find the previous separator */ 10469 while (*psep > path) 10470 { 10471 if (vim_ispathsep(**psep)) 10472 return OK; 10473 mb_ptr_back(path, *psep); 10474 } 10475 10476 return FAIL; 10477 } 10478 10479 /* 10480 * Returns TRUE if "maybe_unique" is unique wrt other_paths in "gap". 10481 * "maybe_unique" is the end portion of "((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[i]". 10482 */ 10483 static int 10484 is_unique(maybe_unique, gap, i) 10485 char_u *maybe_unique; 10486 garray_T *gap; 10487 int i; 10488 { 10489 int j; 10490 int candidate_len; 10491 int other_path_len; 10492 char_u **other_paths = (char_u **)gap->ga_data; 10493 char_u *rival; 10494 10495 for (j = 0; j < gap->ga_len; j++) 10496 { 10497 if (j == i) 10498 continue; /* don't compare it with itself */ 10499 10500 candidate_len = (int)STRLEN(maybe_unique); 10501 other_path_len = (int)STRLEN(other_paths[j]); 10502 if (other_path_len < candidate_len) 10503 continue; /* it's different when it's shorter */ 10504 10505 rival = other_paths[j] + other_path_len - candidate_len; 10506 if (fnamecmp(maybe_unique, rival) == 0 10507 && (rival == other_paths[j] || vim_ispathsep(*(rival - 1)))) 10508 return FALSE; /* match */ 10509 } 10510 10511 return TRUE; /* no match found */ 10512 } 10513 10514 /* 10515 * Split the 'path' option into an array of strings in garray_T. Relative 10516 * paths are expanded to their equivalent fullpath. This includes the "." 10517 * (relative to current buffer directory) and empty path (relative to current 10518 * directory) notations. 10519 * 10520 * TODO: handle upward search (;) and path limiter (**N) notations by 10521 * expanding each into their equivalent path(s). 10522 */ 10523 static void 10524 expand_path_option(curdir, gap) 10525 char_u *curdir; 10526 garray_T *gap; 10527 { 10528 char_u *path_option = *curbuf->b_p_path == NUL 10529 ? p_path : curbuf->b_p_path; 10530 char_u *buf; 10531 char_u *p; 10532 int len; 10533 10534 if ((buf = alloc((int)MAXPATHL)) == NULL) 10535 return; 10536 10537 while (*path_option != NUL) 10538 { 10539 copy_option_part(&path_option, buf, MAXPATHL, " ,"); 10540 10541 if (buf[0] == '.' && (buf[1] == NUL || vim_ispathsep(buf[1]))) 10542 { 10543 /* Relative to current buffer: 10544 * "/path/file" + "." -> "/path/" 10545 * "/path/file" + "./subdir" -> "/path/subdir" */ 10546 if (curbuf->b_ffname == NULL) 10547 continue; 10548 p = gettail(curbuf->b_ffname); 10549 len = (int)(p - curbuf->b_ffname); 10550 if (len + (int)STRLEN(buf) >= MAXPATHL) 10551 continue; 10552 if (buf[1] == NUL) 10553 buf[len] = NUL; 10554 else 10555 STRMOVE(buf + len, buf + 2); 10556 mch_memmove(buf, curbuf->b_ffname, len); 10557 simplify_filename(buf); 10558 } 10559 else if (buf[0] == NUL) 10560 /* relative to current directory */ 10561 STRCPY(buf, curdir); 10562 else if (path_with_url(buf)) 10563 /* URL can't be used here */ 10564 continue; 10565 else if (!mch_isFullName(buf)) 10566 { 10567 /* Expand relative path to their full path equivalent */ 10568 len = (int)STRLEN(curdir); 10569 if (len + (int)STRLEN(buf) + 3 > MAXPATHL) 10570 continue; 10571 STRMOVE(buf + len + 1, buf); 10572 STRCPY(buf, curdir); 10573 buf[len] = PATHSEP; 10574 simplify_filename(buf); 10575 } 10576 10577 if (ga_grow(gap, 1) == FAIL) 10578 break; 10579 10580 # if defined(MSWIN) || defined(MSDOS) 10581 /* Avoid the path ending in a backslash, it fails when a comma is 10582 * appended. */ 10583 len = (int)STRLEN(buf); 10584 if (buf[len - 1] == '\\') 10585 buf[len - 1] = '/'; 10586 # endif 10587 10588 p = vim_strsave(buf); 10589 if (p == NULL) 10590 break; 10591 ((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len++] = p; 10592 } 10593 10594 vim_free(buf); 10595 } 10596 10597 /* 10598 * Returns a pointer to the file or directory name in "fname" that matches the 10599 * longest path in "ga"p, or NULL if there is no match. For example: 10600 * 10601 * path: /foo/bar/baz 10602 * fname: /foo/bar/baz/quux.txt 10603 * returns: ^this 10604 */ 10605 static char_u * 10606 get_path_cutoff(fname, gap) 10607 char_u *fname; 10608 garray_T *gap; 10609 { 10610 int i; 10611 int maxlen = 0; 10612 char_u **path_part = (char_u **)gap->ga_data; 10613 char_u *cutoff = NULL; 10614 10615 for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; i++) 10616 { 10617 int j = 0; 10618 10619 while ((fname[j] == path_part[i][j] 10620 # if defined(MSWIN) || defined(MSDOS) 10621 || (vim_ispathsep(fname[j]) && vim_ispathsep(path_part[i][j])) 10622 #endif 10623 ) && fname[j] != NUL && path_part[i][j] != NUL) 10624 j++; 10625 if (j > maxlen) 10626 { 10627 maxlen = j; 10628 cutoff = &fname[j]; 10629 } 10630 } 10631 10632 /* skip to the file or directory name */ 10633 if (cutoff != NULL) 10634 while (vim_ispathsep(*cutoff)) 10635 mb_ptr_adv(cutoff); 10636 10637 return cutoff; 10638 } 10639 10640 /* 10641 * Sorts, removes duplicates and modifies all the fullpath names in "gap" so 10642 * that they are unique with respect to each other while conserving the part 10643 * that matches the pattern. Beware, this is at least O(n^2) wrt "gap->ga_len". 10644 */ 10645 static void 10646 uniquefy_paths(gap, pattern) 10647 garray_T *gap; 10648 char_u *pattern; 10649 { 10650 int i; 10651 int len; 10652 char_u **fnames = (char_u **)gap->ga_data; 10653 int sort_again = FALSE; 10654 char_u *pat; 10655 char_u *file_pattern; 10656 char_u *curdir; 10657 regmatch_T regmatch; 10658 garray_T path_ga; 10659 char_u **in_curdir = NULL; 10660 char_u *short_name; 10661 10662 remove_duplicates(gap); 10663 ga_init2(&path_ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 1); 10664 10665 /* 10666 * We need to prepend a '*' at the beginning of file_pattern so that the 10667 * regex matches anywhere in the path. FIXME: is this valid for all 10668 * possible patterns? 10669 */ 10670 len = (int)STRLEN(pattern); 10671 file_pattern = alloc(len + 2); 10672 if (file_pattern == NULL) 10673 return; 10674 file_pattern[0] = '*'; 10675 file_pattern[1] = NUL; 10676 STRCAT(file_pattern, pattern); 10677 pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(file_pattern, NULL, NULL, TRUE); 10678 vim_free(file_pattern); 10679 if (pat == NULL) 10680 return; 10681 10682 regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE; /* always ignore case */ 10683 regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC + RE_STRING); 10684 vim_free(pat); 10685 if (regmatch.regprog == NULL) 10686 return; 10687 10688 if ((curdir = alloc((int)(MAXPATHL))) == NULL) 10689 goto theend; 10690 mch_dirname(curdir, MAXPATHL); 10691 expand_path_option(curdir, &path_ga); 10692 10693 in_curdir = (char_u **)alloc_clear(gap->ga_len * sizeof(char_u *)); 10694 if (in_curdir == NULL) 10695 goto theend; 10696 10697 for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len && !got_int; i++) 10698 { 10699 char_u *path = fnames[i]; 10700 int is_in_curdir; 10701 char_u *dir_end = gettail_dir(path); 10702 char_u *pathsep_p; 10703 char_u *path_cutoff; 10704 10705 len = (int)STRLEN(path); 10706 is_in_curdir = fnamencmp(curdir, path, dir_end - path) == 0 10707 && curdir[dir_end - path] == NUL; 10708 if (is_in_curdir) 10709 in_curdir[i] = vim_strsave(path); 10710 10711 /* Shorten the filename while maintaining its uniqueness */ 10712 path_cutoff = get_path_cutoff(path, &path_ga); 10713 10714 /* we start at the end of the path */ 10715 pathsep_p = path + len - 1; 10716 10717 while (find_previous_pathsep(path, &pathsep_p)) 10718 if (vim_regexec(®match, pathsep_p + 1, (colnr_T)0) 10719 && is_unique(pathsep_p + 1, gap, i) 10720 && path_cutoff != NULL && pathsep_p + 1 >= path_cutoff) 10721 { 10722 sort_again = TRUE; 10723 mch_memmove(path, pathsep_p + 1, STRLEN(pathsep_p)); 10724 break; 10725 } 10726 10727 if (mch_isFullName(path)) 10728 { 10729 /* 10730 * Last resort: shorten relative to curdir if possible. 10731 * 'possible' means: 10732 * 1. It is under the current directory. 10733 * 2. The result is actually shorter than the original. 10734 * 10735 * Before curdir After 10736 * /foo/bar/file.txt /foo/bar ./file.txt 10737 * c:\foo\bar\file.txt c:\foo\bar .\file.txt 10738 * /file.txt / /file.txt 10739 * c:\file.txt c:\ .\file.txt 10740 */ 10741 short_name = shorten_fname(path, curdir); 10742 if (short_name != NULL && short_name > path + 1 10743 #if defined(MSWIN) || defined(MSDOS) 10744 /* On windows, 10745 * shorten_fname("c:\a\a.txt", "c:\a\b") 10746 * returns "\a\a.txt", which is not really the short 10747 * name, hence: */ 10748 && !vim_ispathsep(*short_name) 10749 #endif 10750 ) 10751 { 10752 STRCPY(path, "."); 10753 add_pathsep(path); 10754 STRMOVE(path + STRLEN(path), short_name); 10755 } 10756 } 10757 ui_breakcheck(); 10758 } 10759 10760 /* Shorten filenames in /in/current/directory/{filename} */ 10761 for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len && !got_int; i++) 10762 { 10763 char_u *rel_path; 10764 char_u *path = in_curdir[i]; 10765 10766 if (path == NULL) 10767 continue; 10768 10769 /* If the {filename} is not unique, change it to ./{filename}. 10770 * Else reduce it to {filename} */ 10771 short_name = shorten_fname(path, curdir); 10772 if (short_name == NULL) 10773 short_name = path; 10774 if (is_unique(short_name, gap, i)) 10775 { 10776 STRCPY(fnames[i], short_name); 10777 continue; 10778 } 10779 10780 rel_path = alloc((int)(STRLEN(short_name) + STRLEN(PATHSEPSTR) + 2)); 10781 if (rel_path == NULL) 10782 goto theend; 10783 STRCPY(rel_path, "."); 10784 add_pathsep(rel_path); 10785 STRCAT(rel_path, short_name); 10786 10787 vim_free(fnames[i]); 10788 fnames[i] = rel_path; 10789 sort_again = TRUE; 10790 ui_breakcheck(); 10791 } 10792 10793 theend: 10794 vim_free(curdir); 10795 if (in_curdir != NULL) 10796 { 10797 for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; i++) 10798 vim_free(in_curdir[i]); 10799 vim_free(in_curdir); 10800 } 10801 ga_clear_strings(&path_ga); 10802 vim_regfree(regmatch.regprog); 10803 10804 if (sort_again) 10805 remove_duplicates(gap); 10806 } 10807 10808 /* 10809 * Calls globpath() with 'path' values for the given pattern and stores the 10810 * result in "gap". 10811 * Returns the total number of matches. 10812 */ 10813 static int 10814 expand_in_path(gap, pattern, flags) 10815 garray_T *gap; 10816 char_u *pattern; 10817 int flags; /* EW_* flags */ 10818 { 10819 char_u *curdir; 10820 garray_T path_ga; 10821 char_u *paths = NULL; 10822 10823 if ((curdir = alloc((unsigned)MAXPATHL)) == NULL) 10824 return 0; 10825 mch_dirname(curdir, MAXPATHL); 10826 10827 ga_init2(&path_ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 1); 10828 expand_path_option(curdir, &path_ga); 10829 vim_free(curdir); 10830 if (path_ga.ga_len == 0) 10831 return 0; 10832 10833 paths = ga_concat_strings(&path_ga, ","); 10834 ga_clear_strings(&path_ga); 10835 if (paths == NULL) 10836 return 0; 10837 10838 globpath(paths, pattern, gap, (flags & EW_ICASE) ? WILD_ICASE : 0); 10839 vim_free(paths); 10840 10841 return gap->ga_len; 10842 } 10843 #endif 10844 10845 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) || defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO) 10846 /* 10847 * Sort "gap" and remove duplicate entries. "gap" is expected to contain a 10848 * list of file names in allocated memory. 10849 */ 10850 void 10851 remove_duplicates(gap) 10852 garray_T *gap; 10853 { 10854 int i; 10855 int j; 10856 char_u **fnames = (char_u **)gap->ga_data; 10857 10858 sort_strings(fnames, gap->ga_len); 10859 for (i = gap->ga_len - 1; i > 0; --i) 10860 if (fnamecmp(fnames[i - 1], fnames[i]) == 0) 10861 { 10862 vim_free(fnames[i]); 10863 for (j = i + 1; j < gap->ga_len; ++j) 10864 fnames[j - 1] = fnames[j]; 10865 --gap->ga_len; 10866 } 10867 } 10868 #endif 10869 10870 static int has_env_var __ARGS((char_u *p)); 10871 10872 /* 10873 * Return TRUE if "p" contains what looks like an environment variable. 10874 * Allowing for escaping. 10875 */ 10876 static int 10877 has_env_var(p) 10878 char_u *p; 10879 { 10880 for ( ; *p; mb_ptr_adv(p)) 10881 { 10882 if (*p == '\\' && p[1] != NUL) 10883 ++p; 10884 else if (vim_strchr((char_u *) 10885 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) 10886 "$%" 10887 #else 10888 "$" 10889 #endif 10890 , *p) != NULL) 10891 return TRUE; 10892 } 10893 return FALSE; 10894 } 10895 10896 #ifdef SPECIAL_WILDCHAR 10897 static int has_special_wildchar __ARGS((char_u *p)); 10898 10899 /* 10900 * Return TRUE if "p" contains a special wildcard character. 10901 * Allowing for escaping. 10902 */ 10903 static int 10904 has_special_wildchar(p) 10905 char_u *p; 10906 { 10907 for ( ; *p; mb_ptr_adv(p)) 10908 { 10909 if (*p == '\\' && p[1] != NUL) 10910 ++p; 10911 else if (vim_strchr((char_u *)SPECIAL_WILDCHAR, *p) != NULL) 10912 return TRUE; 10913 } 10914 return FALSE; 10915 } 10916 #endif 10917 10918 /* 10919 * Generic wildcard expansion code. 10920 * 10921 * Characters in "pat" that should not be expanded must be preceded with a 10922 * backslash. E.g., "/path\ with\ spaces/my\*star*" 10923 * 10924 * Return FAIL when no single file was found. In this case "num_file" is not 10925 * set, and "file" may contain an error message. 10926 * Return OK when some files found. "num_file" is set to the number of 10927 * matches, "file" to the array of matches. Call FreeWild() later. 10928 */ 10929 int 10930 gen_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags) 10931 int num_pat; /* number of input patterns */ 10932 char_u **pat; /* array of input patterns */ 10933 int *num_file; /* resulting number of files */ 10934 char_u ***file; /* array of resulting files */ 10935 int flags; /* EW_* flags */ 10936 { 10937 int i; 10938 garray_T ga; 10939 char_u *p; 10940 static int recursive = FALSE; 10941 int add_pat; 10942 int retval = OK; 10943 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) 10944 int did_expand_in_path = FALSE; 10945 #endif 10946 10947 /* 10948 * expand_env() is called to expand things like "~user". If this fails, 10949 * it calls ExpandOne(), which brings us back here. In this case, always 10950 * call the machine specific expansion function, if possible. Otherwise, 10951 * return FAIL. 10952 */ 10953 if (recursive) 10954 #ifdef SPECIAL_WILDCHAR 10955 return mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags); 10956 #else 10957 return FAIL; 10958 #endif 10959 10960 #ifdef SPECIAL_WILDCHAR 10961 /* 10962 * If there are any special wildcard characters which we cannot handle 10963 * here, call machine specific function for all the expansion. This 10964 * avoids starting the shell for each argument separately. 10965 * For `=expr` do use the internal function. 10966 */ 10967 for (i = 0; i < num_pat; i++) 10968 { 10969 if (has_special_wildchar(pat[i]) 10970 # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK 10971 && !(vim_backtick(pat[i]) && pat[i][1] == '=') 10972 # endif 10973 ) 10974 return mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags); 10975 } 10976 #endif 10977 10978 recursive = TRUE; 10979 10980 /* 10981 * The matching file names are stored in a growarray. Init it empty. 10982 */ 10983 ga_init2(&ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 30); 10984 10985 for (i = 0; i < num_pat; ++i) 10986 { 10987 add_pat = -1; 10988 p = pat[i]; 10989 10990 #ifdef VIM_BACKTICK 10991 if (vim_backtick(p)) 10992 { 10993 add_pat = expand_backtick(&ga, p, flags); 10994 if (add_pat == -1) 10995 retval = FAIL; 10996 } 10997 else 10998 #endif 10999 { 11000 /* 11001 * First expand environment variables, "~/" and "~user/". 11002 */ 11003 if (has_env_var(p) || *p == '~') 11004 { 11005 p = expand_env_save_opt(p, TRUE); 11006 if (p == NULL) 11007 p = pat[i]; 11008 #ifdef UNIX 11009 /* 11010 * On Unix, if expand_env() can't expand an environment 11011 * variable, use the shell to do that. Discard previously 11012 * found file names and start all over again. 11013 */ 11014 else if (has_env_var(p) || *p == '~') 11015 { 11016 vim_free(p); 11017 ga_clear_strings(&ga); 11018 i = mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, 11019 flags|EW_KEEPDOLLAR); 11020 recursive = FALSE; 11021 return i; 11022 } 11023 #endif 11024 } 11025 11026 /* 11027 * If there are wildcards: Expand file names and add each match to 11028 * the list. If there is no match, and EW_NOTFOUND is given, add 11029 * the pattern. 11030 * If there are no wildcards: Add the file name if it exists or 11031 * when EW_NOTFOUND is given. 11032 */ 11033 if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(p)) 11034 { 11035 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) 11036 if ((flags & EW_PATH) 11037 && !mch_isFullName(p) 11038 && !(p[0] == '.' 11039 && (vim_ispathsep(p[1]) 11040 || (p[1] == '.' && vim_ispathsep(p[2])))) 11041 ) 11042 { 11043 /* :find completion where 'path' is used. 11044 * Recursiveness is OK here. */ 11045 recursive = FALSE; 11046 add_pat = expand_in_path(&ga, p, flags); 11047 recursive = TRUE; 11048 did_expand_in_path = TRUE; 11049 } 11050 else 11051 #endif 11052 add_pat = mch_expandpath(&ga, p, flags); 11053 } 11054 } 11055 11056 if (add_pat == -1 || (add_pat == 0 && (flags & EW_NOTFOUND))) 11057 { 11058 char_u *t = backslash_halve_save(p); 11059 11060 #if defined(MACOS_CLASSIC) 11061 slash_to_colon(t); 11062 #endif 11063 /* When EW_NOTFOUND is used, always add files and dirs. Makes 11064 * "vim c:/" work. */ 11065 if (flags & EW_NOTFOUND) 11066 addfile(&ga, t, flags | EW_DIR | EW_FILE); 11067 else if (mch_getperm(t) >= 0) 11068 addfile(&ga, t, flags); 11069 vim_free(t); 11070 } 11071 11072 #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) 11073 if (did_expand_in_path && ga.ga_len > 0 && (flags & EW_PATH)) 11074 uniquefy_paths(&ga, p); 11075 #endif 11076 if (p != pat[i]) 11077 vim_free(p); 11078 } 11079 11080 *num_file = ga.ga_len; 11081 *file = (ga.ga_data != NULL) ? (char_u **)ga.ga_data : (char_u **)""; 11082 11083 recursive = FALSE; 11084 11085 return (ga.ga_data != NULL) ? retval : FAIL; 11086 } 11087 11088 # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK 11089 11090 /* 11091 * Return TRUE if we can expand this backtick thing here. 11092 */ 11093 static int 11094 vim_backtick(p) 11095 char_u *p; 11096 { 11097 return (*p == '`' && *(p + 1) != NUL && *(p + STRLEN(p) - 1) == '`'); 11098 } 11099 11100 /* 11101 * Expand an item in `backticks` by executing it as a command. 11102 * Currently only works when pat[] starts and ends with a `. 11103 * Returns number of file names found, -1 if an error is encountered. 11104 */ 11105 static int 11106 expand_backtick(gap, pat, flags) 11107 garray_T *gap; 11108 char_u *pat; 11109 int flags; /* EW_* flags */ 11110 { 11111 char_u *p; 11112 char_u *cmd; 11113 char_u *buffer; 11114 int cnt = 0; 11115 int i; 11116 11117 /* Create the command: lop off the backticks. */ 11118 cmd = vim_strnsave(pat + 1, (int)STRLEN(pat) - 2); 11119 if (cmd == NULL) 11120 return -1; 11121 11122 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL 11123 if (*cmd == '=') /* `={expr}`: Expand expression */ 11124 buffer = eval_to_string(cmd + 1, &p, TRUE); 11125 else 11126 #endif 11127 buffer = get_cmd_output(cmd, NULL, 11128 (flags & EW_SILENT) ? SHELL_SILENT : 0, NULL); 11129 vim_free(cmd); 11130 if (buffer == NULL) 11131 return -1; 11132 11133 cmd = buffer; 11134 while (*cmd != NUL) 11135 { 11136 cmd = skipwhite(cmd); /* skip over white space */ 11137 p = cmd; 11138 while (*p != NUL && *p != '\r' && *p != '\n') /* skip over entry */ 11139 ++p; 11140 /* add an entry if it is not empty */ 11141 if (p > cmd) 11142 { 11143 i = *p; 11144 *p = NUL; 11145 addfile(gap, cmd, flags); 11146 *p = i; 11147 ++cnt; 11148 } 11149 cmd = p; 11150 while (*cmd != NUL && (*cmd == '\r' || *cmd == '\n')) 11151 ++cmd; 11152 } 11153 11154 vim_free(buffer); 11155 return cnt; 11156 } 11157 # endif /* VIM_BACKTICK */ 11158 11159 /* 11160 * Add a file to a file list. Accepted flags: 11161 * EW_DIR add directories 11162 * EW_FILE add files 11163 * EW_EXEC add executable files 11164 * EW_NOTFOUND add even when it doesn't exist 11165 * EW_ADDSLASH add slash after directory name 11166 * EW_ALLLINKS add symlink also when the referred file does not exist 11167 */ 11168 void 11169 addfile(gap, f, flags) 11170 garray_T *gap; 11171 char_u *f; /* filename */ 11172 int flags; 11173 { 11174 char_u *p; 11175 int isdir; 11176 struct stat sb; 11177 11178 /* if the file/dir/link doesn't exist, may not add it */ 11179 if (!(flags & EW_NOTFOUND) && ((flags & EW_ALLLINKS) 11180 ? mch_lstat((char *)f, &sb) < 0 : mch_getperm(f) < 0)) 11181 return; 11182 11183 #ifdef FNAME_ILLEGAL 11184 /* if the file/dir contains illegal characters, don't add it */ 11185 if (vim_strpbrk(f, (char_u *)FNAME_ILLEGAL) != NULL) 11186 return; 11187 #endif 11188 11189 isdir = mch_isdir(f); 11190 if ((isdir && !(flags & EW_DIR)) || (!isdir && !(flags & EW_FILE))) 11191 return; 11192 11193 /* If the file isn't executable, may not add it. Do accept directories. 11194 * When invoked from expand_shellcmd() do not use $PATH. */ 11195 if (!isdir && (flags & EW_EXEC) 11196 && !mch_can_exe(f, NULL, !(flags & EW_SHELLCMD))) 11197 return; 11198 11199 /* Make room for another item in the file list. */ 11200 if (ga_grow(gap, 1) == FAIL) 11201 return; 11202 11203 p = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(f) + 1 + isdir)); 11204 if (p == NULL) 11205 return; 11206 11207 STRCPY(p, f); 11208 #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME 11209 slash_adjust(p); 11210 #endif 11211 /* 11212 * Append a slash or backslash after directory names if none is present. 11213 */ 11214 #ifndef DONT_ADD_PATHSEP_TO_DIR 11215 if (isdir && (flags & EW_ADDSLASH)) 11216 add_pathsep(p); 11217 #endif 11218 ((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len++] = p; 11219 } 11220 #endif /* !NO_EXPANDPATH */ 11221 11222 #if defined(VIM_BACKTICK) || defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO) 11223 11224 #ifndef SEEK_SET 11225 # define SEEK_SET 0 11226 #endif 11227 #ifndef SEEK_END 11228 # define SEEK_END 2 11229 #endif 11230 11231 /* 11232 * Get the stdout of an external command. 11233 * If "ret_len" is NULL replace NUL characters with NL. When "ret_len" is not 11234 * NULL store the length there. 11235 * Returns an allocated string, or NULL for error. 11236 */ 11237 char_u * 11238 get_cmd_output(cmd, infile, flags, ret_len) 11239 char_u *cmd; 11240 char_u *infile; /* optional input file name */ 11241 int flags; /* can be SHELL_SILENT */ 11242 int *ret_len; 11243 { 11244 char_u *tempname; 11245 char_u *command; 11246 char_u *buffer = NULL; 11247 int len; 11248 int i = 0; 11249 FILE *fd; 11250 11251 if (check_restricted() || check_secure()) 11252 return NULL; 11253 11254 /* get a name for the temp file */ 11255 if ((tempname = vim_tempname('o', FALSE)) == NULL) 11256 { 11257 EMSG(_(e_notmp)); 11258 return NULL; 11259 } 11260 11261 /* Add the redirection stuff */ 11262 command = make_filter_cmd(cmd, infile, tempname); 11263 if (command == NULL) 11264 goto done; 11265 11266 /* 11267 * Call the shell to execute the command (errors are ignored). 11268 * Don't check timestamps here. 11269 */ 11270 ++no_check_timestamps; 11271 call_shell(command, SHELL_DOOUT | SHELL_EXPAND | flags); 11272 --no_check_timestamps; 11273 11274 vim_free(command); 11275 11276 /* 11277 * read the names from the file into memory 11278 */ 11279 # ifdef VMS 11280 /* created temporary file is not always readable as binary */ 11281 fd = mch_fopen((char *)tempname, "r"); 11282 # else 11283 fd = mch_fopen((char *)tempname, READBIN); 11284 # endif 11285 11286 if (fd == NULL) 11287 { 11288 EMSG2(_(e_notopen), tempname); 11289 goto done; 11290 } 11291 11292 fseek(fd, 0L, SEEK_END); 11293 len = ftell(fd); /* get size of temp file */ 11294 fseek(fd, 0L, SEEK_SET); 11295 11296 buffer = alloc(len + 1); 11297 if (buffer != NULL) 11298 i = (int)fread((char *)buffer, (size_t)1, (size_t)len, fd); 11299 fclose(fd); 11300 mch_remove(tempname); 11301 if (buffer == NULL) 11302 goto done; 11303 #ifdef VMS 11304 len = i; /* VMS doesn't give us what we asked for... */ 11305 #endif 11306 if (i != len) 11307 { 11308 EMSG2(_(e_notread), tempname); 11309 vim_free(buffer); 11310 buffer = NULL; 11311 } 11312 else if (ret_len == NULL) 11313 { 11314 /* Change NUL into SOH, otherwise the string is truncated. */ 11315 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i) 11316 if (buffer[i] == NUL) 11317 buffer[i] = 1; 11318 11319 buffer[len] = NUL; /* make sure the buffer is terminated */ 11320 } 11321 else 11322 *ret_len = len; 11323 11324 done: 11325 vim_free(tempname); 11326 return buffer; 11327 } 11328 #endif 11329 11330 /* 11331 * Free the list of files returned by expand_wildcards() or other expansion 11332 * functions. 11333 */ 11334 void 11335 FreeWild(count, files) 11336 int count; 11337 char_u **files; 11338 { 11339 if (count <= 0 || files == NULL) 11340 return; 11341 #if defined(__EMX__) && defined(__ALWAYS_HAS_TRAILING_NULL_POINTER) /* XXX */ 11342 /* 11343 * Is this still OK for when other functions than expand_wildcards() have 11344 * been used??? 11345 */ 11346 _fnexplodefree((char **)files); 11347 #else 11348 while (count--) 11349 vim_free(files[count]); 11350 vim_free(files); 11351 #endif 11352 } 11353 11354 /* 11355 * Return TRUE when need to go to Insert mode because of 'insertmode'. 11356 * Don't do this when still processing a command or a mapping. 11357 * Don't do this when inside a ":normal" command. 11358 */ 11359 int 11360 goto_im() 11361 { 11362 return (p_im && stuff_empty() && typebuf_typed()); 11363 } 11364 11365 /* 11366 * Returns the isolated name of the shell in allocated memory: 11367 * - Skip beyond any path. E.g., "/usr/bin/csh -f" -> "csh -f". 11368 * - Remove any argument. E.g., "csh -f" -> "csh". 11369 * But don't allow a space in the path, so that this works: 11370 * "/usr/bin/csh --rcfile ~/.cshrc" 11371 * But don't do that for Windows, it's common to have a space in the path. 11372 */ 11373 char_u * 11374 get_isolated_shell_name() 11375 { 11376 char_u *p; 11377 11378 #ifdef WIN3264 11379 p = gettail(p_sh); 11380 p = vim_strnsave(p, (int)(skiptowhite(p) - p)); 11381 #else 11382 p = skiptowhite(p_sh); 11383 if (*p == NUL) 11384 { 11385 /* No white space, use the tail. */ 11386 p = vim_strsave(gettail(p_sh)); 11387 } 11388 else 11389 { 11390 char_u *p1, *p2; 11391 11392 /* Find the last path separator before the space. */ 11393 p1 = p_sh; 11394 for (p2 = p_sh; p2 < p; mb_ptr_adv(p2)) 11395 if (vim_ispathsep(*p2)) 11396 p1 = p2 + 1; 11397 p = vim_strnsave(p1, (int)(p - p1)); 11398 } 11399 #endif 11400 return p; 11401 } 11402